xref: /linux/include/net/mac80211.h (revision 45d43937a44c806b8649323b8f5d9f42ae838b0e)
1 /* SPDX-License-Identifier: GPL-2.0-only */
2 /*
3  * mac80211 <-> driver interface
4  *
5  * Copyright 2002-2005, Devicescape Software, Inc.
6  * Copyright 2006-2007	Jiri Benc <jbenc@suse.cz>
7  * Copyright 2007-2010	Johannes Berg <johannes@sipsolutions.net>
8  * Copyright 2013-2014  Intel Mobile Communications GmbH
9  * Copyright (C) 2015 - 2017 Intel Deutschland GmbH
10  * Copyright (C) 2018 - 2023 Intel Corporation
11  */
12 
13 #ifndef MAC80211_H
14 #define MAC80211_H
15 
16 #include <linux/bug.h>
17 #include <linux/kernel.h>
18 #include <linux/if_ether.h>
19 #include <linux/skbuff.h>
20 #include <linux/ieee80211.h>
21 #include <linux/lockdep.h>
22 #include <net/cfg80211.h>
23 #include <net/codel.h>
24 #include <net/ieee80211_radiotap.h>
25 #include <asm/unaligned.h>
26 
27 /**
28  * DOC: Introduction
29  *
30  * mac80211 is the Linux stack for 802.11 hardware that implements
31  * only partial functionality in hard- or firmware. This document
32  * defines the interface between mac80211 and low-level hardware
33  * drivers.
34  */
35 
36 /**
37  * DOC: Calling mac80211 from interrupts
38  *
39  * Only ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() can be
40  * called in hardware interrupt context. The low-level driver must not call any
41  * other functions in hardware interrupt context. If there is a need for such
42  * call, the low-level driver should first ACK the interrupt and perform the
43  * IEEE 802.11 code call after this, e.g. from a scheduled workqueue or even
44  * tasklet function.
45  *
46  * NOTE: If the driver opts to use the _irqsafe() functions, it may not also
47  *	 use the non-IRQ-safe functions!
48  */
49 
50 /**
51  * DOC: Warning
52  *
53  * If you're reading this document and not the header file itself, it will
54  * be incomplete because not all documentation has been converted yet.
55  */
56 
57 /**
58  * DOC: Frame format
59  *
60  * As a general rule, when frames are passed between mac80211 and the driver,
61  * they start with the IEEE 802.11 header and include the same octets that are
62  * sent over the air except for the FCS which should be calculated by the
63  * hardware.
64  *
65  * There are, however, various exceptions to this rule for advanced features:
66  *
67  * The first exception is for hardware encryption and decryption offload
68  * where the IV/ICV may or may not be generated in hardware.
69  *
70  * Secondly, when the hardware handles fragmentation, the frame handed to
71  * the driver from mac80211 is the MSDU, not the MPDU.
72  */
73 
74 /**
75  * DOC: mac80211 workqueue
76  *
77  * mac80211 provides its own workqueue for drivers and internal mac80211 use.
78  * The workqueue is a single threaded workqueue and can only be accessed by
79  * helpers for sanity checking. Drivers must ensure all work added onto the
80  * mac80211 workqueue should be cancelled on the driver stop() callback.
81  *
82  * mac80211 will flush the workqueue upon interface removal and during
83  * suspend.
84  *
85  * All work performed on the mac80211 workqueue must not acquire the RTNL lock.
86  *
87  */
88 
89 /**
90  * DOC: mac80211 software tx queueing
91  *
92  * mac80211 uses an intermediate queueing implementation, designed to allow the
93  * driver to keep hardware queues short and to provide some fairness between
94  * different stations/interfaces.
95  *
96  * Drivers must provide the .wake_tx_queue driver operation by either
97  * linking it to ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() or implementing a custom
98  * handler.
99  *
100  * Intermediate queues (struct ieee80211_txq) are kept per-sta per-tid, with
101  * another per-sta for non-data/non-mgmt and bufferable management frames, and
102  * a single per-vif queue for multicast data frames.
103  *
104  * The driver is expected to initialize its private per-queue data for stations
105  * and interfaces in the .add_interface and .sta_add ops.
106  *
107  * The driver can't access the internal TX queues (iTXQs) directly.
108  * Whenever mac80211 adds a new frame to a queue, it calls the .wake_tx_queue
109  * driver op.
110  * Drivers implementing a custom .wake_tx_queue op can get them by calling
111  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue(). Drivers using ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue() will
112  * simply get the individual frames pushed via the .tx driver operation.
113  *
114  * Drivers can optionally delegate responsibility for scheduling queues to
115  * mac80211, to take advantage of airtime fairness accounting. In this case, to
116  * obtain the next queue to pull frames from, the driver calls
117  * ieee80211_next_txq(). The driver is then expected to return the txq using
118  * ieee80211_return_txq().
119  *
120  * For AP powersave TIM handling, the driver only needs to indicate if it has
121  * buffered packets in the driver specific data structures by calling
122  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(). For frames buffered in the ieee80211_txq
123  * struct, mac80211 sets the appropriate TIM PVB bits and calls
124  * .release_buffered_frames().
125  * In that callback the driver is therefore expected to release its own
126  * buffered frames and afterwards also frames from the ieee80211_txq (obtained
127  * via the usual ieee80211_tx_dequeue).
128  */
129 
130 /**
131  * DOC: HW timestamping
132  *
133  * Timing Measurement and Fine Timing Measurement require accurate timestamps
134  * of the action frames TX/RX and their respective acks.
135  *
136  * To report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine Timing
137  * Measurement frame RX, the low level driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp
138  * field to the frame RX timestamp and report the ack TX timestamp in the
139  * ieee80211_rx_status struct.
140  *
141  * Similarly, to report hardware timestamps for Timing Measurement or Fine
142  * Timing Measurement frame TX, the driver should set the SKB's hwtstamp field
143  * to the frame TX timestamp and report the ack RX timestamp in the
144  * ieee80211_tx_status struct.
145  */
146 struct device;
147 
148 /**
149  * enum ieee80211_max_queues - maximum number of queues
150  *
151  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES: Maximum number of regular device queues.
152  * @IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP: bitmap with maximum queues set
153  */
154 enum ieee80211_max_queues {
155 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES =		16,
156 	IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUE_MAP =	BIT(IEEE80211_MAX_QUEUES) - 1,
157 };
158 
159 #define IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE	0xff
160 
161 /**
162  * enum ieee80211_ac_numbers - AC numbers as used in mac80211
163  * @IEEE80211_AC_VO: voice
164  * @IEEE80211_AC_VI: video
165  * @IEEE80211_AC_BE: best effort
166  * @IEEE80211_AC_BK: background
167  */
168 enum ieee80211_ac_numbers {
169 	IEEE80211_AC_VO		= 0,
170 	IEEE80211_AC_VI		= 1,
171 	IEEE80211_AC_BE		= 2,
172 	IEEE80211_AC_BK		= 3,
173 };
174 
175 /**
176  * struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params - transmit queue configuration
177  *
178  * The information provided in this structure is required for QoS
179  * transmit queue configuration. Cf. IEEE 802.11 7.3.2.29.
180  *
181  * @aifs: arbitration interframe space [0..255]
182  * @cw_min: minimum contention window [a value of the form
183  *	2^n-1 in the range 1..32767]
184  * @cw_max: maximum contention window [like @cw_min]
185  * @txop: maximum burst time in units of 32 usecs, 0 meaning disabled
186  * @acm: is mandatory admission control required for the access category
187  * @uapsd: is U-APSD mode enabled for the queue
188  * @mu_edca: is the MU EDCA configured
189  * @mu_edca_param_rec: MU EDCA Parameter Record for HE
190  */
191 struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params {
192 	u16 txop;
193 	u16 cw_min;
194 	u16 cw_max;
195 	u8 aifs;
196 	bool acm;
197 	bool uapsd;
198 	bool mu_edca;
199 	struct ieee80211_he_mu_edca_param_ac_rec mu_edca_param_rec;
200 };
201 
202 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats {
203 	unsigned int dot11ACKFailureCount;
204 	unsigned int dot11RTSFailureCount;
205 	unsigned int dot11FCSErrorCount;
206 	unsigned int dot11RTSSuccessCount;
207 };
208 
209 /**
210  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_change - change flag for channel context
211  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH: The channel width changed
212  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS: The number of RX chains changed
213  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR: radar detection flag changed
214  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL: switched to another operating channel,
215  *	this is used only with channel switching with CSA
216  * @IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH: The min required channel width changed
217  */
218 enum ieee80211_chanctx_change {
219 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_WIDTH		= BIT(0),
220 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RX_CHAINS	= BIT(1),
221 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_RADAR		= BIT(2),
222 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_CHANNEL	= BIT(3),
223 	IEEE80211_CHANCTX_CHANGE_MIN_WIDTH	= BIT(4),
224 };
225 
226 /**
227  * struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf - channel context that vifs may be tuned to
228  *
229  * This is the driver-visible part. The ieee80211_chanctx
230  * that contains it is visible in mac80211 only.
231  *
232  * @def: the channel definition
233  * @min_def: the minimum channel definition currently required.
234  * @rx_chains_static: The number of RX chains that must always be
235  *	active on the channel to receive MIMO transmissions
236  * @rx_chains_dynamic: The number of RX chains that must be enabled
237  *	after RTS/CTS handshake to receive SMPS MIMO transmissions;
238  *	this will always be >= @rx_chains_static.
239  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled on this channel.
240  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
241  *	sizeof(void *), size is determined in hw information.
242  */
243 struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf {
244 	struct cfg80211_chan_def def;
245 	struct cfg80211_chan_def min_def;
246 
247 	u8 rx_chains_static, rx_chains_dynamic;
248 
249 	bool radar_enabled;
250 
251 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
252 };
253 
254 /**
255  * enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode - channel context switch mode
256  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF: Both old and new contexts already
257  *	exist (and will continue to exist), but the virtual interface
258  *	needs to be switched from one to the other.
259  * @CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS: The old context exists but will stop
260  *      to exist with this call, the new context doesn't exist but
261  *      will be active after this call, the virtual interface switches
262  *      from the old to the new (note that the driver may of course
263  *      implement this as an on-the-fly chandef switch of the existing
264  *      hardware context, but the mac80211 pointer for the old context
265  *      will cease to exist and only the new one will later be used
266  *      for changes/removal.)
267  */
268 enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode {
269 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_REASSIGN_VIF,
270 	CHANCTX_SWMODE_SWAP_CONTEXTS,
271 };
272 
273 /**
274  * struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch - vif chanctx switch information
275  *
276  * This is structure is used to pass information about a vif that
277  * needs to switch from one chanctx to another.  The
278  * &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode defines how the switch should be
279  * done.
280  *
281  * @vif: the vif that should be switched from old_ctx to new_ctx
282  * @link_conf: the link conf that's switching
283  * @old_ctx: the old context to which the vif was assigned
284  * @new_ctx: the new context to which the vif must be assigned
285  */
286 struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch {
287 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
288 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf;
289 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *old_ctx;
290 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *new_ctx;
291 };
292 
293 /**
294  * enum ieee80211_bss_change - BSS change notification flags
295  *
296  * These flags are used with the bss_info_changed(), link_info_changed()
297  * and vif_cfg_changed() callbacks to indicate which parameter(s) changed.
298  *
299  * @BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC: association status changed (associated/disassociated),
300  *	also implies a change in the AID.
301  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT: CTS protection changed
302  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE: preamble changed
303  * @BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT: slot timing changed
304  * @BSS_CHANGED_HT: 802.11n parameters changed
305  * @BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES: Basic rateset changed
306  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT: Beacon interval changed
307  * @BSS_CHANGED_BSSID: BSSID changed, for whatever
308  *	reason (IBSS and managed mode)
309  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON: Beacon data changed, retrieve
310  *	new beacon (beaconing modes)
311  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED: Beaconing should be
312  *	enabled/disabled (beaconing modes)
313  * @BSS_CHANGED_CQM: Connection quality monitor config changed
314  * @BSS_CHANGED_IBSS: IBSS join status changed
315  * @BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER: Hardware ARP filter address list or state changed.
316  * @BSS_CHANGED_QOS: QoS for this association was enabled/disabled. Note
317  *	that it is only ever disabled for station mode.
318  * @BSS_CHANGED_IDLE: Idle changed for this BSS/interface.
319  * @BSS_CHANGED_SSID: SSID changed for this BSS (AP and IBSS mode)
320  * @BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP: Probe Response changed for this BSS (AP mode)
321  * @BSS_CHANGED_PS: PS changed for this BSS (STA mode)
322  * @BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER: TX power setting changed for this interface
323  * @BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS: P2P powersave settings (CTWindow, opportunistic PS)
324  *	changed
325  * @BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO: Data from the AP's beacon became available:
326  *	currently dtim_period only is under consideration.
327  * @BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH: The bandwidth used by this interface changed,
328  *	note that this is only called when it changes after the channel
329  *	context had been assigned.
330  * @BSS_CHANGED_OCB: OCB join status changed
331  * @BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS: VHT MU-MIMO group id or user position changed
332  * @BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE: keep alive options (idle period or protected
333  *	keep alive) changed.
334  * @BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE: Multicast Rate setting changed for this interface
335  * @BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER: fine timing measurement request responder
336  *	functionality changed for this BSS (AP mode).
337  * @BSS_CHANGED_TWT: TWT status changed
338  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD: OBSS Packet Detection status changed.
339  * @BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR: BSS Color has changed
340  * @BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY: FILS discovery status changed.
341  * @BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
342  *	status changed.
343  * @BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING: The channel puncturing bitmap changed.
344  * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS: MLD valid links status changed.
345  * @BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM: TID to link mapping was changed
346  */
347 enum ieee80211_bss_change {
348 	BSS_CHANGED_ASSOC		= 1<<0,
349 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_CTS_PROT	= 1<<1,
350 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_PREAMBLE	= 1<<2,
351 	BSS_CHANGED_ERP_SLOT		= 1<<3,
352 	BSS_CHANGED_HT			= 1<<4,
353 	BSS_CHANGED_BASIC_RATES		= 1<<5,
354 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INT		= 1<<6,
355 	BSS_CHANGED_BSSID		= 1<<7,
356 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON		= 1<<8,
357 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_ENABLED	= 1<<9,
358 	BSS_CHANGED_CQM			= 1<<10,
359 	BSS_CHANGED_IBSS		= 1<<11,
360 	BSS_CHANGED_ARP_FILTER		= 1<<12,
361 	BSS_CHANGED_QOS			= 1<<13,
362 	BSS_CHANGED_IDLE		= 1<<14,
363 	BSS_CHANGED_SSID		= 1<<15,
364 	BSS_CHANGED_AP_PROBE_RESP	= 1<<16,
365 	BSS_CHANGED_PS			= 1<<17,
366 	BSS_CHANGED_TXPOWER		= 1<<18,
367 	BSS_CHANGED_P2P_PS		= 1<<19,
368 	BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO		= 1<<20,
369 	BSS_CHANGED_BANDWIDTH		= 1<<21,
370 	BSS_CHANGED_OCB                 = 1<<22,
371 	BSS_CHANGED_MU_GROUPS		= 1<<23,
372 	BSS_CHANGED_KEEP_ALIVE		= 1<<24,
373 	BSS_CHANGED_MCAST_RATE		= 1<<25,
374 	BSS_CHANGED_FTM_RESPONDER	= 1<<26,
375 	BSS_CHANGED_TWT			= 1<<27,
376 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_OBSS_PD		= 1<<28,
377 	BSS_CHANGED_HE_BSS_COLOR	= 1<<29,
378 	BSS_CHANGED_FILS_DISCOVERY      = 1<<30,
379 	BSS_CHANGED_UNSOL_BCAST_PROBE_RESP = 1<<31,
380 	BSS_CHANGED_EHT_PUNCTURING	= BIT_ULL(32),
381 	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_VALID_LINKS	= BIT_ULL(33),
382 	BSS_CHANGED_MLD_TTLM		= BIT_ULL(34),
383 
384 	/* when adding here, make sure to change ieee80211_reconfig */
385 };
386 
387 /*
388  * The maximum number of IPv4 addresses listed for ARP filtering. If the number
389  * of addresses for an interface increase beyond this value, hardware ARP
390  * filtering will be disabled.
391  */
392 #define IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN 4
393 
394 /**
395  * enum ieee80211_event_type - event to be notified to the low level driver
396  * @RSSI_EVENT: AP's rssi crossed the a threshold set by the driver.
397  * @MLME_EVENT: event related to MLME
398  * @BAR_RX_EVENT: a BAR was received
399  * @BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT: Frames were released from the reordering buffer because
400  *	they timed out. This won't be called for each frame released, but only
401  *	once each time the timeout triggers.
402  */
403 enum ieee80211_event_type {
404 	RSSI_EVENT,
405 	MLME_EVENT,
406 	BAR_RX_EVENT,
407 	BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT,
408 };
409 
410 /**
411  * enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data - relevant when event type is %RSSI_EVENT
412  * @RSSI_EVENT_HIGH: AP's rssi went below the threshold set by the driver.
413  * @RSSI_EVENT_LOW: AP's rssi went above the threshold set by the driver.
414  */
415 enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data {
416 	RSSI_EVENT_HIGH,
417 	RSSI_EVENT_LOW,
418 };
419 
420 /**
421  * struct ieee80211_rssi_event - data attached to an %RSSI_EVENT
422  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data
423  */
424 struct ieee80211_rssi_event {
425 	enum ieee80211_rssi_event_data data;
426 };
427 
428 /**
429  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
430  * @AUTH_EVENT: the MLME operation is authentication
431  * @ASSOC_EVENT: the MLME operation is association
432  * @DEAUTH_RX_EVENT: deauth received..
433  * @DEAUTH_TX_EVENT: deauth sent.
434  */
435 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data {
436 	AUTH_EVENT,
437 	ASSOC_EVENT,
438 	DEAUTH_RX_EVENT,
439 	DEAUTH_TX_EVENT,
440 };
441 
442 /**
443  * enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status - relevant when event type is %MLME_EVENT
444  * @MLME_SUCCESS: the MLME operation completed successfully.
445  * @MLME_DENIED: the MLME operation was denied by the peer.
446  * @MLME_TIMEOUT: the MLME operation timed out.
447  */
448 enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status {
449 	MLME_SUCCESS,
450 	MLME_DENIED,
451 	MLME_TIMEOUT,
452 };
453 
454 /**
455  * struct ieee80211_mlme_event - data attached to an %MLME_EVENT
456  * @data: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data
457  * @status: See &enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status
458  * @reason: the reason code if applicable
459  */
460 struct ieee80211_mlme_event {
461 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_data data;
462 	enum ieee80211_mlme_event_status status;
463 	u16 reason;
464 };
465 
466 /**
467  * struct ieee80211_ba_event - data attached for BlockAck related events
468  * @sta: pointer to the &ieee80211_sta to which this event relates
469  * @tid: the tid
470  * @ssn: the starting sequence number (for %BAR_RX_EVENT)
471  */
472 struct ieee80211_ba_event {
473 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
474 	u16 tid;
475 	u16 ssn;
476 };
477 
478 /**
479  * struct ieee80211_event - event to be sent to the driver
480  * @type: The event itself. See &enum ieee80211_event_type.
481  * @u.rssi: relevant if &type is %RSSI_EVENT
482  * @u.mlme: relevant if &type is %AUTH_EVENT
483  * @u.ba: relevant if &type is %BAR_RX_EVENT or %BA_FRAME_TIMEOUT
484  * @u:union holding the fields above
485  */
486 struct ieee80211_event {
487 	enum ieee80211_event_type type;
488 	union {
489 		struct ieee80211_rssi_event rssi;
490 		struct ieee80211_mlme_event mlme;
491 		struct ieee80211_ba_event ba;
492 	} u;
493 };
494 
495 /**
496  * struct ieee80211_mu_group_data - STA's VHT MU-MIMO group data
497  *
498  * This structure describes the group id data of VHT MU-MIMO
499  *
500  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
501  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
502  */
503 struct ieee80211_mu_group_data {
504 	u8 membership[WLAN_MEMBERSHIP_LEN];
505 	u8 position[WLAN_USER_POSITION_LEN];
506 };
507 
508 /**
509  * struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params - FTM responder parameters
510  *
511  * @lci: LCI subelement content
512  * @civicloc: CIVIC location subelement content
513  * @lci_len: LCI data length
514  * @civicloc_len: Civic data length
515  */
516 struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params {
517 	const u8 *lci;
518 	const u8 *civicloc;
519 	size_t lci_len;
520 	size_t civicloc_len;
521 };
522 
523 /**
524  * struct ieee80211_fils_discovery - FILS discovery parameters from
525  * IEEE Std 802.11ai-2016, Annex C.3 MIB detail.
526  *
527  * @min_interval: Minimum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
528  * @max_interval: Maximum packet interval in TUs (0 - 10000)
529  */
530 struct ieee80211_fils_discovery {
531 	u32 min_interval;
532 	u32 max_interval;
533 };
534 
535 /**
536  * struct ieee80211_bss_conf - holds the BSS's changing parameters
537  *
538  * This structure keeps information about a BSS (and an association
539  * to that BSS) that can change during the lifetime of the BSS.
540  *
541  * @vif: reference to owning VIF
542  * @addr: (link) address used locally
543  * @link_id: link ID, or 0 for non-MLO
544  * @htc_trig_based_pkt_ext: default PE in 4us units, if BSS supports HE
545  * @uora_exists: is the UORA element advertised by AP
546  * @uora_ocw_range: UORA element's OCW Range field
547  * @frame_time_rts_th: HE duration RTS threshold, in units of 32us
548  * @he_support: does this BSS support HE
549  * @twt_requester: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
550  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
551  * @twt_responder: does this BSS support TWT requester (relevant for managed
552  *	mode only, set if the AP advertises TWT responder role)
553  * @twt_protected: does this BSS support protected TWT frames
554  * @twt_broadcast: does this BSS support broadcast TWT
555  * @use_cts_prot: use CTS protection
556  * @use_short_preamble: use 802.11b short preamble
557  * @use_short_slot: use short slot time (only relevant for ERP)
558  * @dtim_period: num of beacons before the next DTIM, for beaconing,
559  *	valid in station mode only if after the driver was notified
560  *	with the %BSS_CHANGED_BEACON_INFO flag, will be non-zero then.
561  * @sync_tsf: last beacon's/probe response's TSF timestamp (could be old
562  *	as it may have been received during scanning long ago). If the
563  *	HW flag %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY is set, then this can
564  *	only come from a beacon, but might not become valid until after
565  *	association when a beacon is received (which is notified with the
566  *	%BSS_CHANGED_DTIM flag.). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
567  * @sync_device_ts: the device timestamp corresponding to the sync_tsf,
568  *	the driver/device can use this to calculate synchronisation
569  *	(see @sync_tsf). See also sync_dtim_count important notice.
570  * @sync_dtim_count: Only valid when %IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY
571  *	is requested, see @sync_tsf/@sync_device_ts.
572  *	IMPORTANT: These three sync_* parameters would possibly be out of sync
573  *	by the time the driver will use them. The synchronized view is currently
574  *	guaranteed only in certain callbacks.
575  *	Note also that this is not used with MLD associations, mac80211 doesn't
576  *	know how to track beacons for all of the links for this.
577  * @beacon_int: beacon interval
578  * @assoc_capability: capabilities taken from assoc resp
579  * @basic_rates: bitmap of basic rates, each bit stands for an
580  *	index into the rate table configured by the driver in
581  *	the current band.
582  * @beacon_rate: associated AP's beacon TX rate
583  * @mcast_rate: per-band multicast rate index + 1 (0: disabled)
584  * @bssid: The BSSID for this BSS
585  * @enable_beacon: whether beaconing should be enabled or not
586  * @chandef: Channel definition for this BSS -- the hardware might be
587  *	configured a higher bandwidth than this BSS uses, for example.
588  * @mu_group: VHT MU-MIMO group membership data
589  * @ht_operation_mode: HT operation mode like in &struct ieee80211_ht_operation.
590  *	This field is only valid when the channel is a wide HT/VHT channel.
591  *	Note that with TDLS this can be the case (channel is HT, protection must
592  *	be used from this field) even when the BSS association isn't using HT.
593  * @cqm_rssi_thold: Connection quality monitor RSSI threshold, a zero value
594  *	implies disabled. As with the cfg80211 callback, a change here should
595  *	cause an event to be sent indicating where the current value is in
596  *	relation to the newly configured threshold.
597  * @cqm_rssi_low: Connection quality monitor RSSI lower threshold, a zero value
598  *	implies disabled.  This is an alternative mechanism to the single
599  *	threshold event and can't be enabled simultaneously with it.
600  * @cqm_rssi_high: Connection quality monitor RSSI upper threshold.
601  * @cqm_rssi_hyst: Connection quality monitor RSSI hysteresis
602  * @qos: This is a QoS-enabled BSS.
603  * @hidden_ssid: The SSID of the current vif is hidden. Only valid in AP-mode.
604  * @txpower: TX power in dBm.  INT_MIN means not configured.
605  * @txpower_type: TX power adjustment used to control per packet Transmit
606  *	Power Control (TPC) in lower driver for the current vif. In particular
607  *	TPC is enabled if value passed in %txpower_type is
608  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED (allow using less than specified from
609  *	userspace), whereas TPC is disabled if %txpower_type is set to
610  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED (use value configured from userspace)
611  * @p2p_noa_attr: P2P NoA attribute for P2P powersave
612  * @allow_p2p_go_ps: indication for AP or P2P GO interface, whether it's allowed
613  *	to use P2P PS mechanism or not. AP/P2P GO is not allowed to use P2P PS
614  *	if it has associated clients without P2P PS support.
615  * @max_idle_period: the time period during which the station can refrain from
616  *	transmitting frames to its associated AP without being disassociated.
617  *	In units of 1000 TUs. Zero value indicates that the AP did not include
618  *	a (valid) BSS Max Idle Period Element.
619  * @protected_keep_alive: if set, indicates that the station should send an RSN
620  *	protected frame to the AP to reset the idle timer at the AP for the
621  *	station.
622  * @ftm_responder: whether to enable or disable fine timing measurement FTM
623  *	responder functionality.
624  * @ftmr_params: configurable lci/civic parameter when enabling FTM responder.
625  * @nontransmitted: this BSS is a nontransmitted BSS profile
626  * @transmitter_bssid: the address of transmitter AP
627  * @bssid_index: index inside the multiple BSSID set
628  * @bssid_indicator: 2^bssid_indicator is the maximum number of APs in set
629  * @ema_ap: AP supports enhancements of discovery and advertisement of
630  *	nontransmitted BSSIDs
631  * @profile_periodicity: the least number of beacon frames need to be received
632  *	in order to discover all the nontransmitted BSSIDs in the set.
633  * @he_oper: HE operation information of the BSS (AP/Mesh) or of the AP we are
634  *	connected to (STA)
635  * @he_obss_pd: OBSS Packet Detection parameters.
636  * @he_bss_color: BSS coloring settings, if BSS supports HE
637  * @fils_discovery: FILS discovery configuration
638  * @unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval: Unsolicited broadcast probe response
639  *	interval.
640  * @beacon_tx_rate: The configured beacon transmit rate that needs to be passed
641  *	to driver when rate control is offloaded to firmware.
642  * @power_type: power type of BSS for 6 GHz
643  * @tx_pwr_env: transmit power envelope array of BSS.
644  * @tx_pwr_env_num: number of @tx_pwr_env.
645  * @pwr_reduction: power constraint of BSS.
646  * @eht_support: does this BSS support EHT
647  * @eht_puncturing: bitmap to indicate which channels are punctured in this BSS
648  * @csa_active: marks whether a channel switch is going on.
649  * @csa_punct_bitmap: new puncturing bitmap for channel switch
650  * @mu_mimo_owner: indicates interface owns MU-MIMO capability
651  * @chanctx_conf: The channel context this interface is assigned to, or %NULL
652  *	when it is not assigned. This pointer is RCU-protected due to the TX
653  *	path needing to access it; even though the netdev carrier will always
654  *	be off when it is %NULL there can still be races and packets could be
655  *	processed after it switches back to %NULL.
656  * @color_change_active: marks whether a color change is ongoing.
657  * @color_change_color: the bss color that will be used after the change.
658  * @ht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HT LDPC capability.
659  * @vht_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has VHT LDPC capability.
660  * @he_ldpc: in AP mode, indicates interface has HE LDPC capability.
661  * @vht_su_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
662  *	beamformer
663  * @vht_su_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT SU
664  *	beamformee
665  * @vht_mu_beamformer: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
666  *	beamformer
667  * @vht_mu_beamformee: in AP mode, does this BSS support operation as an VHT MU
668  *	beamformee
669  * @he_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
670  *	beamformer
671  * @he_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE SU
672  *	beamformee
673  * @he_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS support operation as an HE MU
674  *	beamformer
675  * @he_full_ul_mumimo: does this BSS support the reception (AP) or transmission
676  *	(non-AP STA) of an HE TB PPDU on an RU that spans the entire PPDU
677  *	bandwidth
678  * @eht_su_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
679  *	beamformer
680  * @eht_su_beamformee: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT SU
681  *	beamformee
682  * @eht_mu_beamformer: in AP-mode, does this BSS enable operation as an EHT MU
683  *	beamformer
684  */
685 struct ieee80211_bss_conf {
686 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
687 
688 	const u8 *bssid;
689 	unsigned int link_id;
690 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
691 	u8 htc_trig_based_pkt_ext;
692 	bool uora_exists;
693 	u8 uora_ocw_range;
694 	u16 frame_time_rts_th;
695 	bool he_support;
696 	bool twt_requester;
697 	bool twt_responder;
698 	bool twt_protected;
699 	bool twt_broadcast;
700 	/* erp related data */
701 	bool use_cts_prot;
702 	bool use_short_preamble;
703 	bool use_short_slot;
704 	bool enable_beacon;
705 	u8 dtim_period;
706 	u16 beacon_int;
707 	u16 assoc_capability;
708 	u64 sync_tsf;
709 	u32 sync_device_ts;
710 	u8 sync_dtim_count;
711 	u32 basic_rates;
712 	struct ieee80211_rate *beacon_rate;
713 	int mcast_rate[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
714 	u16 ht_operation_mode;
715 	s32 cqm_rssi_thold;
716 	u32 cqm_rssi_hyst;
717 	s32 cqm_rssi_low;
718 	s32 cqm_rssi_high;
719 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
720 	struct ieee80211_mu_group_data mu_group;
721 	bool qos;
722 	bool hidden_ssid;
723 	int txpower;
724 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting txpower_type;
725 	struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr p2p_noa_attr;
726 	bool allow_p2p_go_ps;
727 	u16 max_idle_period;
728 	bool protected_keep_alive;
729 	bool ftm_responder;
730 	struct ieee80211_ftm_responder_params *ftmr_params;
731 	/* Multiple BSSID data */
732 	bool nontransmitted;
733 	u8 transmitter_bssid[ETH_ALEN];
734 	u8 bssid_index;
735 	u8 bssid_indicator;
736 	bool ema_ap;
737 	u8 profile_periodicity;
738 	struct {
739 		u32 params;
740 		u16 nss_set;
741 	} he_oper;
742 	struct ieee80211_he_obss_pd he_obss_pd;
743 	struct cfg80211_he_bss_color he_bss_color;
744 	struct ieee80211_fils_discovery fils_discovery;
745 	u32 unsol_bcast_probe_resp_interval;
746 	struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask beacon_tx_rate;
747 	enum ieee80211_ap_reg_power power_type;
748 	struct ieee80211_tx_pwr_env tx_pwr_env[IEEE80211_TPE_MAX_IE_COUNT];
749 	u8 tx_pwr_env_num;
750 	u8 pwr_reduction;
751 	bool eht_support;
752 	u16 eht_puncturing;
753 
754 	bool csa_active;
755 	u16 csa_punct_bitmap;
756 
757 	bool mu_mimo_owner;
758 	struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf __rcu *chanctx_conf;
759 
760 	bool color_change_active;
761 	u8 color_change_color;
762 
763 	bool ht_ldpc;
764 	bool vht_ldpc;
765 	bool he_ldpc;
766 	bool vht_su_beamformer;
767 	bool vht_su_beamformee;
768 	bool vht_mu_beamformer;
769 	bool vht_mu_beamformee;
770 	bool he_su_beamformer;
771 	bool he_su_beamformee;
772 	bool he_mu_beamformer;
773 	bool he_full_ul_mumimo;
774 	bool eht_su_beamformer;
775 	bool eht_su_beamformee;
776 	bool eht_mu_beamformer;
777 };
778 
779 /**
780  * enum mac80211_tx_info_flags - flags to describe transmission information/status
781  *
782  * These flags are used with the @flags member of &ieee80211_tx_info.
783  *
784  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS: require TX status callback for this frame.
785  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ: The driver has to assign a sequence
786  *	number to this frame, taking care of not overwriting the fragment
787  *	number and increasing the sequence number only when the
788  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT flag is set. mac80211 will properly
789  *	assign sequence numbers to QoS-data frames but cannot do so correctly
790  *	for non-QoS-data and management frames because beacons need them from
791  *	that counter as well and mac80211 cannot guarantee proper sequencing.
792  *	If this flag is set, the driver should instruct the hardware to
793  *	assign a sequence number to the frame or assign one itself. Cf. IEEE
794  *	802.11-2007 7.1.3.4.1 paragraph 3. This flag will always be set for
795  *	beacons and always be clear for frames without a sequence number field.
796  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK: tell the low level not to wait for an ack
797  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT: clear powersave filter for destination
798  *	station
799  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT: this is a first fragment of the frame
800  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM: send this frame after DTIM beacon
801  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU: this frame should be sent as part of an A-MPDU
802  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED: Frame was injected, internal to mac80211.
803  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED: The frame was not transmitted
804  *	because the destination STA was in powersave mode. Note that to
805  *	avoid race conditions, the filter must be set by the hardware or
806  *	firmware upon receiving a frame that indicates that the station
807  *	went to sleep (must be done on device to filter frames already on
808  *	the queue) and may only be unset after mac80211 gives the OK for
809  *	that by setting the IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT (see above),
810  *	since only then is it guaranteed that no more frames are in the
811  *	hardware queue.
812  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK: Frame was acknowledged
813  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU: The frame was aggregated, so status
814  * 	is for the whole aggregation.
815  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK: no block ack was returned,
816  * 	so consider using block ack request (BAR).
817  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE: internal to mac80211, can be
818  *	set by rate control algorithms to indicate probe rate, will
819  *	be cleared for fragmented frames (except on the last fragment)
820  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK: Internal to mac80211. Used to indicate
821  *	that a frame can be transmitted while the queues are stopped for
822  *	off-channel operation.
823  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP: This frame uses hardware encapsulation
824  *	(header conversion)
825  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED: completely internal to mac80211,
826  *	used to indicate that a frame was already retried due to PS
827  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT: completely internal to mac80211,
828  *	used to indicate frame should not be encrypted
829  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER: This frame is a response to a poll
830  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD) or a non-bufferable MMPDU and must
831  *	be sent although the station is in powersave mode.
832  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES: More frames will be passed to the
833  *	transmit function after the current frame, this can be used
834  *	by drivers to kick the DMA queue only if unset or when the
835  *	queue gets full.
836  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION: This frame is being retransmitted
837  *	after TX status because the destination was asleep, it must not
838  *	be modified again (no seqno assignment, crypto, etc.)
839  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX: This frame was transmitted by the MLME
840  *	code for connection establishment, this indicates that its status
841  *	should kick the MLME state machine.
842  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX: Frame was requested through nl80211
843  *	MLME command (internal to mac80211 to figure out whether to send TX
844  *	status to user space)
845  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC: tells the driver to use LDPC for this frame
846  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC: Enables Space-Time Block Coding (STBC) for this
847  *	frame and selects the maximum number of streams that it can use.
848  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN: Marks this packet to be transmitted on
849  *	the off-channel channel when a remain-on-channel offload is done
850  *	in hardware -- normal packets still flow and are expected to be
851  *	handled properly by the device.
852  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE: Marks this packet to be used for TKIP
853  *	testing. It will be sent out with incorrect Michael MIC key to allow
854  *	TKIP countermeasures to be tested.
855  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE: This frame will be sent at non CCK rate.
856  *	This flag is actually used for management frame especially for P2P
857  *	frames not being sent at CCK rate in 2GHz band.
858  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP: This packet marks the end of service period,
859  *	when its status is reported the service period ends. For frames in
860  *	an SP that mac80211 transmits, it is already set; for driver frames
861  *	the driver may set this flag. It is also used to do the same for
862  *	PS-Poll responses.
863  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE: This frame will be sent at lowest rate.
864  *	This flag is used to send nullfunc frame at minimum rate when
865  *	the nullfunc is used for connection monitoring purpose.
866  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG: Don't fragment this packet even if it
867  *	would be fragmented by size (this is optional, only used for
868  *	monitor injection).
869  * @IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED: A frame that was marked with
870  *	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK has been successfully transmitted without
871  *	any errors (like issues specific to the driver/HW).
872  *	This flag must not be set for frames that don't request no-ack
873  *	behaviour with IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK.
874  *
875  * Note: If you have to add new flags to the enumeration, then don't
876  *	 forget to update %IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS when necessary.
877  */
878 enum mac80211_tx_info_flags {
879 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS		= BIT(0),
880 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_ASSIGN_SEQ		= BIT(1),
881 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK			= BIT(2),
882 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT		= BIT(3),
883 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT		= BIT(4),
884 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM	= BIT(5),
885 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU			= BIT(6),
886 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_INJECTED		= BIT(7),
887 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED		= BIT(8),
888 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK			= BIT(9),
889 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU			= BIT(10),
890 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK		= BIT(11),
891 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE	= BIT(12),
892 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_OFFCHAN_TX_OK	= BIT(13),
893 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP		= BIT(14),
894 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRIED		= BIT(15),
895 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_DONT_ENCRYPT		= BIT(16),
896 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER		= BIT(17),
897 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES		= BIT(18),
898 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_RETRANSMISSION	= BIT(19),
899 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_MLME_CONN_TX		= BIT(20),
900 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_NL80211_FRAME_TX	= BIT(21),
901 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC			= BIT(22),
902 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC			= BIT(23) | BIT(24),
903 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN		= BIT(25),
904 	IEEE80211_TX_INTFL_TKIP_MIC_FAILURE	= BIT(26),
905 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_CCK_RATE		= BIT(27),
906 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP		= BIT(28),
907 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_USE_MINRATE		= BIT(29),
908 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_DONTFRAG		= BIT(30),
909 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_NOACK_TRANSMITTED	= BIT(31),
910 };
911 
912 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC_SHIFT		23
913 
914 #define IEEE80211_TX_RC_S1G_MCS IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS
915 
916 /**
917  * enum mac80211_tx_control_flags - flags to describe transmit control
918  *
919  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO: this frame is a port control
920  *	protocol frame (e.g. EAP)
921  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE: This frame is a response to a poll
922  *	frame (PS-Poll or uAPSD).
923  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT: This frame is injected with rate information
924  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU: This frame is an A-MSDU frame
925  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT: This frame is going through the fast_xmit path
926  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP: This frame skips mesh path lookup
927  * @IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING: completely internal to mac80211,
928  *	used to indicate that a pending frame requires TX processing before
929  *	it can be sent out.
930  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO: Do not overwrite the sequence number that
931  *	has already been assigned to this frame.
932  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER: This frame should not be reordered
933  *	relative to other frames that have this flag set, independent
934  *	of their QoS TID or other priority field values.
935  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX: first MLO TX, used mostly internally
936  *	for sequence number assignment
937  * @IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK: If not @IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, this
938  *	frame should be transmitted on the specific link. This really is
939  *	only relevant for frames that do not have data present, and is
940  *	also not used for 802.3 format frames. Note that even if the frame
941  *	is on a specific link, address translation might still apply if
942  *	it's intended for an MLD.
943  *
944  * These flags are used in tx_info->control.flags.
945  */
946 enum mac80211_tx_control_flags {
947 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PORT_CTRL_PROTO	= BIT(0),
948 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_PS_RESPONSE		= BIT(1),
949 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_RATE_INJECT		= BIT(2),
950 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_AMSDU			= BIT(3),
951 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_FAST_XMIT		= BIT(4),
952 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_SKIP_MPATH_LOOKUP	= BIT(5),
953 	IEEE80211_TX_INTCFL_NEED_TXPROCESSING	= BIT(6),
954 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_NO_SEQNO		= BIT(7),
955 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_DONT_REORDER		= BIT(8),
956 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MCAST_MLO_FIRST_TX	= BIT(9),
957 	IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK		= 0xf0000000,
958 };
959 
960 #define IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED	0xf
961 #define IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK_UNSPEC	\
962 	u32_encode_bits(IEEE80211_LINK_UNSPECIFIED, \
963 			IEEE80211_TX_CTRL_MLO_LINK)
964 
965 /**
966  * enum mac80211_tx_status_flags - flags to describe transmit status
967  *
968  * @IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID: ACK signal is valid
969  *
970  * These flags are used in tx_info->status.flags.
971  */
972 enum mac80211_tx_status_flags {
973 	IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_ACK_SIGNAL_VALID = BIT(0),
974 };
975 
976 /*
977  * This definition is used as a mask to clear all temporary flags, which are
978  * set by the tx handlers for each transmission attempt by the mac80211 stack.
979  */
980 #define IEEE80211_TX_TEMPORARY_FLAGS (IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_ACK |		      \
981 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_CLEAR_PS_FILT | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_FIRST_FRAGMENT |    \
982 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_SEND_AFTER_DTIM | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_AMPDU |	      \
983 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED |	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_ACK |		      \
984 	IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU | IEEE80211_TX_STAT_AMPDU_NO_BACK |	      \
985 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_RATE_CTRL_PROBE | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER |    \
986 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_MORE_FRAMES | IEEE80211_TX_CTL_LDPC |		      \
987 	IEEE80211_TX_CTL_STBC | IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
988 
989 /**
990  * enum mac80211_rate_control_flags - per-rate flags set by the
991  *	Rate Control algorithm.
992  *
993  * These flags are set by the Rate control algorithm for each rate during tx,
994  * in the @flags member of struct ieee80211_tx_rate.
995  *
996  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS: Use RTS/CTS exchange for this rate.
997  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT: CTS-to-self protection is required.
998  *	This is set if the current BSS requires ERP protection.
999  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE: Use short preamble.
1000  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS: HT rate.
1001  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS: VHT MCS rate, in this case the idx field is split
1002  *	into a higher 4 bits (Nss) and lower 4 bits (MCS number)
1003  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD: Indicates whether this rate should be used in
1004  *	Greenfield mode.
1005  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates if the Channel Width should be 40 MHz.
1006  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 80 MHz transmission
1007  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH: Indicates 160 MHz transmission
1008  *	(80+80 isn't supported yet)
1009  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA: The frame should be transmitted on both of the
1010  *	adjacent 20 MHz channels, if the current channel type is
1011  *	NL80211_CHAN_HT40MINUS or NL80211_CHAN_HT40PLUS.
1012  * @IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI: Short Guard interval should be used for this rate.
1013  */
1014 enum mac80211_rate_control_flags {
1015 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_RTS_CTS		= BIT(0),
1016 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_CTS_PROTECT		= BIT(1),
1017 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_USE_SHORT_PREAMBLE	= BIT(2),
1018 
1019 	/* rate index is an HT/VHT MCS instead of an index */
1020 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_MCS			= BIT(3),
1021 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_GREEN_FIELD		= BIT(4),
1022 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_40_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(5),
1023 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_DUP_DATA		= BIT(6),
1024 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_SHORT_GI		= BIT(7),
1025 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_VHT_MCS			= BIT(8),
1026 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_80_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(9),
1027 	IEEE80211_TX_RC_160_MHZ_WIDTH		= BIT(10),
1028 };
1029 
1030 
1031 /* there are 40 bytes if you don't need the rateset to be kept */
1032 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 40
1033 
1034 /* if you do need the rateset, then you have less space */
1035 #define IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE 24
1036 
1037 /* maximum number of rate stages */
1038 #define IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES	4
1039 
1040 /* maximum number of rate table entries */
1041 #define IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE	4
1042 
1043 /**
1044  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate - rate selection/status
1045  *
1046  * @idx: rate index to attempt to send with
1047  * @flags: rate control flags (&enum mac80211_rate_control_flags)
1048  * @count: number of tries in this rate before going to the next rate
1049  *
1050  * A value of -1 for @idx indicates an invalid rate and, if used
1051  * in an array of retry rates, that no more rates should be tried.
1052  *
1053  * When used for transmit status reporting, the driver should
1054  * always report the rate along with the flags it used.
1055  *
1056  * &struct ieee80211_tx_info contains an array of these structs
1057  * in the control information, and it will be filled by the rate
1058  * control algorithm according to what should be sent. For example,
1059  * if this array contains, in the format { <idx>, <count> } the
1060  * information::
1061  *
1062  *    { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 4 }, { -1, 0 }, { -1, 0 }
1063  *
1064  * then this means that the frame should be transmitted
1065  * up to twice at rate 3, up to twice at rate 2, and up to four
1066  * times at rate 1 if it doesn't get acknowledged. Say it gets
1067  * acknowledged by the peer after the fifth attempt, the status
1068  * information should then contain::
1069  *
1070  *   { 3, 2 }, { 2, 2 }, { 1, 1 }, { -1, 0 } ...
1071  *
1072  * since it was transmitted twice at rate 3, twice at rate 2
1073  * and once at rate 1 after which we received an acknowledgement.
1074  */
1075 struct ieee80211_tx_rate {
1076 	s8 idx;
1077 	u16 count:5,
1078 	    flags:11;
1079 } __packed;
1080 
1081 #define IEEE80211_MAX_TX_RETRY		31
1082 
1083 static inline bool ieee80211_rate_valid(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1084 {
1085 	return rate->idx >= 0 && rate->count > 0;
1086 }
1087 
1088 static inline void ieee80211_rate_set_vht(struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate,
1089 					  u8 mcs, u8 nss)
1090 {
1091 	WARN_ON(mcs & ~0xF);
1092 	WARN_ON((nss - 1) & ~0x7);
1093 	rate->idx = ((nss - 1) << 4) | mcs;
1094 }
1095 
1096 static inline u8
1097 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_mcs(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1098 {
1099 	return rate->idx & 0xF;
1100 }
1101 
1102 static inline u8
1103 ieee80211_rate_get_vht_nss(const struct ieee80211_tx_rate *rate)
1104 {
1105 	return (rate->idx >> 4) + 1;
1106 }
1107 
1108 /**
1109  * struct ieee80211_tx_info - skb transmit information
1110  *
1111  * This structure is placed in skb->cb for three uses:
1112  *  (1) mac80211 TX control - mac80211 tells the driver what to do
1113  *  (2) driver internal use (if applicable)
1114  *  (3) TX status information - driver tells mac80211 what happened
1115  *
1116  * @flags: transmit info flags, defined above
1117  * @band: the band to transmit on (use e.g. for checking for races),
1118  *	not valid if the interface is an MLD since we won't know which
1119  *	link the frame will be transmitted on
1120  * @hw_queue: HW queue to put the frame on, skb_get_queue_mapping() gives the AC
1121  * @status_data: internal data for TX status handling, assigned privately,
1122  *	see also &enum ieee80211_status_data for the internal documentation
1123  * @status_data_idr: indicates status data is IDR allocated ID for ack frame
1124  * @tx_time_est: TX time estimate in units of 4us, used internally
1125  * @control: union part for control data
1126  * @control.rates: TX rates array to try
1127  * @control.rts_cts_rate_idx: rate for RTS or CTS
1128  * @control.use_rts: use RTS
1129  * @control.use_cts_prot: use RTS/CTS
1130  * @control.short_preamble: use short preamble (CCK only)
1131  * @control.skip_table: skip externally configured rate table
1132  * @control.jiffies: timestamp for expiry on powersave clients
1133  * @control.vif: virtual interface (may be NULL)
1134  * @control.hw_key: key to encrypt with (may be NULL)
1135  * @control.flags: control flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_control_flags
1136  * @control.enqueue_time: enqueue time (for iTXQs)
1137  * @driver_rates: alias to @control.rates to reserve space
1138  * @pad: padding
1139  * @rate_driver_data: driver use area if driver needs @control.rates
1140  * @status: union part for status data
1141  * @status.rates: attempted rates
1142  * @status.ack_signal: ACK signal
1143  * @status.ampdu_ack_len: AMPDU ack length
1144  * @status.ampdu_len: AMPDU length
1145  * @status.antenna: (legacy, kept only for iwlegacy)
1146  * @status.tx_time: airtime consumed for transmission; note this is only
1147  *	used for WMM AC, not for airtime fairness
1148  * @status.flags: status flags, see &enum mac80211_tx_status_flags
1149  * @status.status_driver_data: driver use area
1150  * @ack: union part for pure ACK data
1151  * @ack.cookie: cookie for the ACK
1152  * @driver_data: array of driver_data pointers
1153  */
1154 struct ieee80211_tx_info {
1155 	/* common information */
1156 	u32 flags;
1157 	u32 band:3,
1158 	    status_data_idr:1,
1159 	    status_data:13,
1160 	    hw_queue:4,
1161 	    tx_time_est:10;
1162 	/* 1 free bit */
1163 
1164 	union {
1165 		struct {
1166 			union {
1167 				/* rate control */
1168 				struct {
1169 					struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[
1170 						IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1171 					s8 rts_cts_rate_idx;
1172 					u8 use_rts:1;
1173 					u8 use_cts_prot:1;
1174 					u8 short_preamble:1;
1175 					u8 skip_table:1;
1176 
1177 					/* for injection only (bitmap) */
1178 					u8 antennas:2;
1179 
1180 					/* 14 bits free */
1181 				};
1182 				/* only needed before rate control */
1183 				unsigned long jiffies;
1184 			};
1185 			/* NB: vif can be NULL for injected frames */
1186 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
1187 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *hw_key;
1188 			u32 flags;
1189 			codel_time_t enqueue_time;
1190 		} control;
1191 		struct {
1192 			u64 cookie;
1193 		} ack;
1194 		struct {
1195 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate rates[IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1196 			s32 ack_signal;
1197 			u8 ampdu_ack_len;
1198 			u8 ampdu_len;
1199 			u8 antenna;
1200 			u8 pad;
1201 			u16 tx_time;
1202 			u8 flags;
1203 			u8 pad2;
1204 			void *status_driver_data[16 / sizeof(void *)];
1205 		} status;
1206 		struct {
1207 			struct ieee80211_tx_rate driver_rates[
1208 				IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES];
1209 			u8 pad[4];
1210 
1211 			void *rate_driver_data[
1212 				IEEE80211_TX_INFO_RATE_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1213 		};
1214 		void *driver_data[
1215 			IEEE80211_TX_INFO_DRIVER_DATA_SIZE / sizeof(void *)];
1216 	};
1217 };
1218 
1219 static inline u16
1220 ieee80211_info_set_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info, u16 tx_time_est)
1221 {
1222 	/* We only have 10 bits in tx_time_est, so store airtime
1223 	 * in increments of 4us and clamp the maximum to 2**12-1
1224 	 */
1225 	info->tx_time_est = min_t(u16, tx_time_est, 4095) >> 2;
1226 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1227 }
1228 
1229 static inline u16
1230 ieee80211_info_get_tx_time_est(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1231 {
1232 	return info->tx_time_est << 2;
1233 }
1234 
1235 /***
1236  * struct ieee80211_rate_status - mrr stage for status path
1237  *
1238  * This struct is used in struct ieee80211_tx_status to provide drivers a
1239  * dynamic way to report about used rates and power levels per packet.
1240  *
1241  * @rate_idx The actual used rate.
1242  * @try_count How often the rate was tried.
1243  * @tx_power_idx An idx into the ieee80211_hw->tx_power_levels list of the
1244  * 	corresponding wifi hardware. The idx shall point to the power level
1245  * 	that was used when sending the packet.
1246  */
1247 struct ieee80211_rate_status {
1248 	struct rate_info rate_idx;
1249 	u8 try_count;
1250 	u8 tx_power_idx;
1251 };
1252 
1253 /**
1254  * struct ieee80211_tx_status - extended tx status info for rate control
1255  *
1256  * @sta: Station that the packet was transmitted for
1257  * @info: Basic tx status information
1258  * @skb: Packet skb (can be NULL if not provided by the driver)
1259  * @rates: Mrr stages that were used when sending the packet
1260  * @n_rates: Number of mrr stages (count of instances for @rates)
1261  * @free_list: list where processed skbs are stored to be free'd by the driver
1262  * @ack_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp of the received ack in nanoseconds
1263  *	Only needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action
1264  *	frames. Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1265  */
1266 struct ieee80211_tx_status {
1267 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
1268 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info;
1269 	struct sk_buff *skb;
1270 	struct ieee80211_rate_status *rates;
1271 	ktime_t ack_hwtstamp;
1272 	u8 n_rates;
1273 
1274 	struct list_head *free_list;
1275 };
1276 
1277 /**
1278  * struct ieee80211_scan_ies - descriptors for different blocks of IEs
1279  *
1280  * This structure is used to point to different blocks of IEs in HW scan
1281  * and scheduled scan. These blocks contain the IEs passed by userspace
1282  * and the ones generated by mac80211.
1283  *
1284  * @ies: pointers to band specific IEs.
1285  * @len: lengths of band_specific IEs.
1286  * @common_ies: IEs for all bands (especially vendor specific ones)
1287  * @common_ie_len: length of the common_ies
1288  */
1289 struct ieee80211_scan_ies {
1290 	const u8 *ies[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1291 	size_t len[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
1292 	const u8 *common_ies;
1293 	size_t common_ie_len;
1294 };
1295 
1296 
1297 static inline struct ieee80211_tx_info *IEEE80211_SKB_CB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1298 {
1299 	return (struct ieee80211_tx_info *)skb->cb;
1300 }
1301 
1302 static inline struct ieee80211_rx_status *IEEE80211_SKB_RXCB(struct sk_buff *skb)
1303 {
1304 	return (struct ieee80211_rx_status *)skb->cb;
1305 }
1306 
1307 /**
1308  * ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status - clear TX status
1309  *
1310  * @info: The &struct ieee80211_tx_info to be cleared.
1311  *
1312  * When the driver passes an skb back to mac80211, it must report
1313  * a number of things in TX status. This function clears everything
1314  * in the TX status but the rate control information (it does clear
1315  * the count since you need to fill that in anyway).
1316  *
1317  * NOTE: While the rates array is kept intact, this will wipe all of the
1318  *	 driver_data fields in info, so it's up to the driver to restore
1319  *	 any fields it needs after calling this helper.
1320  */
1321 static inline void
1322 ieee80211_tx_info_clear_status(struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
1323 {
1324 	int i;
1325 
1326 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1327 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, control.rates));
1328 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) !=
1329 		     offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, driver_rates));
1330 	BUILD_BUG_ON(offsetof(struct ieee80211_tx_info, status.rates) != 8);
1331 	/* clear the rate counts */
1332 	for (i = 0; i < IEEE80211_TX_MAX_RATES; i++)
1333 		info->status.rates[i].count = 0;
1334 	memset_after(&info->status, 0, rates);
1335 }
1336 
1337 
1338 /**
1339  * enum mac80211_rx_flags - receive flags
1340  *
1341  * These flags are used with the @flag member of &struct ieee80211_rx_status.
1342  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR: Michael MIC error was reported on this frame.
1343  *	Use together with %RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED.
1344  * @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED: This frame was decrypted in hardware.
1345  * @RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED: the Michael MIC is stripped off this frame,
1346  *	verification has been done by the hardware.
1347  * @RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED: The IV and ICV are stripped from this frame.
1348  *	If this flag is set, the stack cannot do any replay detection
1349  *	hence the driver or hardware will have to do that.
1350  * @RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED: Currently only valid for CCMP/GCMP frames, this
1351  *	flag indicates that the PN was verified for replay protection.
1352  *	Note that this flag is also currently only supported when a frame
1353  *	is also decrypted (ie. @RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED must be set)
1354  * @RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED: The driver should set this flag if it did
1355  *	de-duplication by itself.
1356  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC: Set this flag if the FCS check failed on
1357  *	the frame.
1358  * @RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC: Set this flag if the PCLP check failed on
1359  *	the frame.
1360  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1361  *	field) is valid if this field is non-zero, and the position
1362  *	where the timestamp was sampled depends on the value.
1363  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1364  *	field) is valid and contains the time the first symbol of the MPDU
1365  *	was received. This is useful in monitor mode and for proper IBSS
1366  *	merging.
1367  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1368  *	field) is valid and contains the time the last symbol of the MPDU
1369  *	(including FCS) was received.
1370  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START: The timestamp passed in the RX status (@mactime
1371  *	field) is valid and contains the time the SYNC preamble was received.
1372  * @RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64: The timestamp passed in the RX status @mactime
1373  *	is only for use in the radiotap timestamp header, not otherwise a valid
1374  *	@mactime value. Note this is a separate flag so that we continue to see
1375  *	%RX_FLAG_MACTIME as unset. Also note that in this case the timestamp is
1376  *	reported to be 64 bits wide, not just 32.
1377  * @RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL: The signal strength value is not present.
1378  *	Valid only for data frames (mainly A-MPDU)
1379  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS: A-MPDU details are known, in particular the reference
1380  *	number (@ampdu_reference) must be populated and be a distinct number for
1381  *	each A-MPDU
1382  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN: last subframe is known, should be set on all
1383  *	subframes of a single A-MPDU
1384  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST: this subframe is the last subframe of the A-MPDU
1385  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR: A delimiter CRC error has been detected
1386  *	on this subframe
1387  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN: The delimiter CRC field is known (the CRC
1388  *	is stored in the @ampdu_delimiter_crc field)
1389  * @RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED: The mic was stripped of this packet. Decryption was
1390  *	done by the hardware
1391  * @RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR: Report frame only to monitor interfaces without
1392  *	processing it in any regular way.
1393  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1394  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1395  * @RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR: Process and report frame to all interfaces except
1396  *	monitor interfaces.
1397  *	This is useful if drivers offload some frames but still want to report
1398  *	them for sniffing purposes.
1399  * @RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE: Some drivers may prefer to report separate A-MSDU
1400  *	subframes instead of a one huge frame for performance reasons.
1401  *	All, but the last MSDU from an A-MSDU should have this flag set. E.g.
1402  *	if an A-MSDU has 3 frames, the first 2 must have the flag set, while
1403  *	the 3rd (last) one must not have this flag set. The flag is used to
1404  *	deal with retransmission/duplication recovery properly since A-MSDU
1405  *	subframes share the same sequence number. Reported subframes can be
1406  *	either regular MSDU or singly A-MSDUs. Subframes must not be
1407  *	interleaved with other frames.
1408  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END: This frame contains radiotap TLVs in the
1409  *	skb->data (before the 802.11 header).
1410  *	If used, the SKB's mac_header pointer must be set to point
1411  *	to the 802.11 header after the TLVs, and any padding added after TLV
1412  *	data to align to 4 must be cleared by the driver putting the TLVs
1413  *	in the skb.
1414  * @RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN: Allow the same PN as same packet before.
1415  *	This is used for AMSDU subframes which can have the same PN as
1416  *	the first subframe.
1417  * @RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED: The ICV is stripped from this frame. CRC checking must
1418  *	be done in the hardware.
1419  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT: Value of the EOF bit in the A-MPDU delimiter for this
1420  *	frame
1421  * @RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN: The EOF value is known
1422  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE: HE radiotap data is present
1423  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he, mac80211 will fill in
1424  *
1425  *	 - DATA3_DATA_MCS
1426  *	 - DATA3_DATA_DCM
1427  *	 - DATA3_CODING
1428  *	 - DATA5_GI
1429  *	 - DATA5_DATA_BW_RU_ALLOC
1430  *	 - DATA6_NSTS
1431  *	 - DATA3_STBC
1432  *
1433  *	from the RX info data, so leave those zeroed when building this data)
1434  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU: HE MU radiotap data is present
1435  *	(&struct ieee80211_radiotap_he_mu)
1436  * @RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG: L-SIG radiotap data is present
1437  * @RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU: use the frame only for radiotap reporting, with
1438  *	the "0-length PSDU" field included there.  The value for it is
1439  *	in &struct ieee80211_rx_status.  Note that if this value isn't
1440  *	known the frame shouldn't be reported.
1441  * @RX_FLAG_8023: the frame has an 802.3 header (decap offload performed by
1442  *	hardware or driver)
1443  */
1444 enum mac80211_rx_flags {
1445 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_ERROR		= BIT(0),
1446 	RX_FLAG_DECRYPTED		= BIT(1),
1447 	RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR		= BIT(2),
1448 	RX_FLAG_MMIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(3),
1449 	RX_FLAG_IV_STRIPPED		= BIT(4),
1450 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC		= BIT(5),
1451 	RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC 	= BIT(6),
1452 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_IS_RTAP_TS64	= BIT(7),
1453 	RX_FLAG_NO_SIGNAL_VAL		= BIT(8),
1454 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DETAILS		= BIT(9),
1455 	RX_FLAG_PN_VALIDATED		= BIT(10),
1456 	RX_FLAG_DUP_VALIDATED		= BIT(11),
1457 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_LAST_KNOWN	= BIT(12),
1458 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_IS_LAST		= BIT(13),
1459 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_ERROR	= BIT(14),
1460 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_DELIM_CRC_KNOWN	= BIT(15),
1461 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME			= BIT(16) | BIT(17),
1462 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_PLCP_START	= 1 << 16,
1463 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_START		= 2 << 16,
1464 	RX_FLAG_MACTIME_END		= 3 << 16,
1465 	RX_FLAG_SKIP_MONITOR		= BIT(18),
1466 	RX_FLAG_AMSDU_MORE		= BIT(19),
1467 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_TLV_AT_END	= BIT(20),
1468 	RX_FLAG_MIC_STRIPPED		= BIT(21),
1469 	RX_FLAG_ALLOW_SAME_PN		= BIT(22),
1470 	RX_FLAG_ICV_STRIPPED		= BIT(23),
1471 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT		= BIT(24),
1472 	RX_FLAG_AMPDU_EOF_BIT_KNOWN	= BIT(25),
1473 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE		= BIT(26),
1474 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_HE_MU		= BIT(27),
1475 	RX_FLAG_RADIOTAP_LSIG		= BIT(28),
1476 	RX_FLAG_NO_PSDU			= BIT(29),
1477 	RX_FLAG_8023			= BIT(30),
1478 };
1479 
1480 /**
1481  * enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags - MCS & bandwidth flags
1482  *
1483  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE: Short preamble was used for this frame
1484  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI: Short guard interval was used
1485  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF: This frame was received in a HT-greenfield transmission,
1486  *	if the driver fills this value it should add
1487  *	%IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_FMT
1488  *	to @hw.radiotap_mcs_details to advertise that fact.
1489  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC: LDPC was used
1490  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK: STBC 2 bit bitmask. 1 - Nss=1, 2 - Nss=2, 3 - Nss=3
1491  * @RX_ENC_FLAG_BF: packet was beamformed
1492  */
1493 enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags {
1494 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORTPRE		= BIT(0),
1495 	RX_ENC_FLAG_SHORT_GI		= BIT(2),
1496 	RX_ENC_FLAG_HT_GF		= BIT(3),
1497 	RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_MASK		= BIT(4) | BIT(5),
1498 	RX_ENC_FLAG_LDPC		= BIT(6),
1499 	RX_ENC_FLAG_BF			= BIT(7),
1500 };
1501 
1502 #define RX_ENC_FLAG_STBC_SHIFT		4
1503 
1504 enum mac80211_rx_encoding {
1505 	RX_ENC_LEGACY = 0,
1506 	RX_ENC_HT,
1507 	RX_ENC_VHT,
1508 	RX_ENC_HE,
1509 	RX_ENC_EHT,
1510 };
1511 
1512 /**
1513  * struct ieee80211_rx_status - receive status
1514  *
1515  * The low-level driver should provide this information (the subset
1516  * supported by hardware) to the 802.11 code with each received
1517  * frame, in the skb's control buffer (cb).
1518  *
1519  * @mactime: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization Function
1520  * 	(TSF) timer when the first data symbol (MPDU) arrived at the hardware.
1521  * @boottime_ns: CLOCK_BOOTTIME timestamp the frame was received at, this is
1522  *	needed only for beacons and probe responses that update the scan cache.
1523  * @ack_tx_hwtstamp: Hardware timestamp for the ack TX in nanoseconds. Only
1524  *	needed for Timing measurement and Fine timing measurement action frames.
1525  *	Only reported by devices that have timestamping enabled.
1526  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, mac80211 doesn't use
1527  *	it but can store it and pass it back to the driver for synchronisation
1528  * @band: the active band when this frame was received
1529  * @freq: frequency the radio was tuned to when receiving this frame, in MHz
1530  *	This field must be set for management frames, but isn't strictly needed
1531  *	for data (other) frames - for those it only affects radiotap reporting.
1532  * @freq_offset: @freq has a positive offset of 500Khz.
1533  * @signal: signal strength when receiving this frame, either in dBm, in dB or
1534  *	unspecified depending on the hardware capabilities flags
1535  *	@IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_*
1536  * @chains: bitmask of receive chains for which separate signal strength
1537  *	values were filled.
1538  * @chain_signal: per-chain signal strength, in dBm (unlike @signal, doesn't
1539  *	support dB or unspecified units)
1540  * @antenna: antenna used
1541  * @rate_idx: index of data rate into band's supported rates or MCS index if
1542  *	HT or VHT is used (%RX_FLAG_HT/%RX_FLAG_VHT)
1543  * @nss: number of streams (VHT, HE and EHT only)
1544  * @flag: %RX_FLAG_\*
1545  * @encoding: &enum mac80211_rx_encoding
1546  * @bw: &enum rate_info_bw
1547  * @enc_flags: uses bits from &enum mac80211_rx_encoding_flags
1548  * @he_ru: HE RU, from &enum nl80211_he_ru_alloc
1549  * @he_gi: HE GI, from &enum nl80211_he_gi
1550  * @he_dcm: HE DCM value
1551  * @eht: EHT specific rate information
1552  * @eht.ru: EHT RU, from &enum nl80211_eht_ru_alloc
1553  * @eht.gi: EHT GI, from &enum nl80211_eht_gi
1554  * @rx_flags: internal RX flags for mac80211
1555  * @ampdu_reference: A-MPDU reference number, must be a different value for
1556  *	each A-MPDU but the same for each subframe within one A-MPDU
1557  * @ampdu_delimiter_crc: A-MPDU delimiter CRC
1558  * @zero_length_psdu_type: radiotap type of the 0-length PSDU
1559  * @link_valid: if the link which is identified by @link_id is valid. This flag
1560  *	is set only when connection is MLO.
1561  * @link_id: id of the link used to receive the packet. This is used along with
1562  *	@link_valid.
1563  */
1564 struct ieee80211_rx_status {
1565 	u64 mactime;
1566 	union {
1567 		u64 boottime_ns;
1568 		ktime_t ack_tx_hwtstamp;
1569 	};
1570 	u32 device_timestamp;
1571 	u32 ampdu_reference;
1572 	u32 flag;
1573 	u16 freq: 13, freq_offset: 1;
1574 	u8 enc_flags;
1575 	u8 encoding:3, bw:4;
1576 	union {
1577 		struct {
1578 			u8 he_ru:3;
1579 			u8 he_gi:2;
1580 			u8 he_dcm:1;
1581 		};
1582 		struct {
1583 			u8 ru:4;
1584 			u8 gi:2;
1585 		} eht;
1586 	};
1587 	u8 rate_idx;
1588 	u8 nss;
1589 	u8 rx_flags;
1590 	u8 band;
1591 	u8 antenna;
1592 	s8 signal;
1593 	u8 chains;
1594 	s8 chain_signal[IEEE80211_MAX_CHAINS];
1595 	u8 ampdu_delimiter_crc;
1596 	u8 zero_length_psdu_type;
1597 	u8 link_valid:1, link_id:4;
1598 };
1599 
1600 static inline u32
1601 ieee80211_rx_status_to_khz(struct ieee80211_rx_status *rx_status)
1602 {
1603 	return MHZ_TO_KHZ(rx_status->freq) +
1604 	       (rx_status->freq_offset ? 500 : 0);
1605 }
1606 
1607 /**
1608  * enum ieee80211_conf_flags - configuration flags
1609  *
1610  * Flags to define PHY configuration options
1611  *
1612  * @IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR: there's a monitor interface present -- use this
1613  *	to determine for example whether to calculate timestamps for packets
1614  *	or not, do not use instead of filter flags!
1615  * @IEEE80211_CONF_PS: Enable 802.11 power save mode (managed mode only).
1616  *	This is the power save mode defined by IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2,
1617  *	meaning that the hardware still wakes up for beacons, is able to
1618  *	transmit frames and receive the possible acknowledgment frames.
1619  *	Not to be confused with hardware specific wakeup/sleep states,
1620  *	driver is responsible for that. See the section "Powersave support"
1621  *	for more.
1622  * @IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE: The device is running, but idle; if the flag is set
1623  *	the driver should be prepared to handle configuration requests but
1624  *	may turn the device off as much as possible. Typically, this flag will
1625  *	be set when an interface is set UP but not associated or scanning, but
1626  *	it can also be unset in that case when monitor interfaces are active.
1627  * @IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL: The device is currently not on its main
1628  *	operating channel.
1629  */
1630 enum ieee80211_conf_flags {
1631 	IEEE80211_CONF_MONITOR		= (1<<0),
1632 	IEEE80211_CONF_PS		= (1<<1),
1633 	IEEE80211_CONF_IDLE		= (1<<2),
1634 	IEEE80211_CONF_OFFCHANNEL	= (1<<3),
1635 };
1636 
1637 
1638 /**
1639  * enum ieee80211_conf_changed - denotes which configuration changed
1640  *
1641  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL: the listen interval changed
1642  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR: the monitor flag changed
1643  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS: the PS flag or dynamic PS timeout changed
1644  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER: the TX power changed
1645  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL: the channel/channel_type changed
1646  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS: retry limits changed
1647  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE: Idle flag changed
1648  * @IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS: Spatial multiplexing powersave mode changed
1649  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1650  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1651  */
1652 enum ieee80211_conf_changed {
1653 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_SMPS		= BIT(1),
1654 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_LISTEN_INTERVAL	= BIT(2),
1655 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_MONITOR		= BIT(3),
1656 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_PS		= BIT(4),
1657 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_POWER		= BIT(5),
1658 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_CHANNEL		= BIT(6),
1659 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_RETRY_LIMITS	= BIT(7),
1660 	IEEE80211_CONF_CHANGE_IDLE		= BIT(8),
1661 };
1662 
1663 /**
1664  * enum ieee80211_smps_mode - spatial multiplexing power save mode
1665  *
1666  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC: automatic
1667  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF: off
1668  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC: static
1669  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC: dynamic
1670  * @IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES: internal, don't use
1671  */
1672 enum ieee80211_smps_mode {
1673 	IEEE80211_SMPS_AUTOMATIC,
1674 	IEEE80211_SMPS_OFF,
1675 	IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC,
1676 	IEEE80211_SMPS_DYNAMIC,
1677 
1678 	/* keep last */
1679 	IEEE80211_SMPS_NUM_MODES,
1680 };
1681 
1682 /**
1683  * struct ieee80211_conf - configuration of the device
1684  *
1685  * This struct indicates how the driver shall configure the hardware.
1686  *
1687  * @flags: configuration flags defined above
1688  *
1689  * @listen_interval: listen interval in units of beacon interval
1690  * @ps_dtim_period: The DTIM period of the AP we're connected to, for use
1691  *	in power saving. Power saving will not be enabled until a beacon
1692  *	has been received and the DTIM period is known.
1693  * @dynamic_ps_timeout: The dynamic powersave timeout (in ms), see the
1694  *	powersave documentation below. This variable is valid only when
1695  *	the CONF_PS flag is set.
1696  *
1697  * @power_level: requested transmit power (in dBm), backward compatibility
1698  *	value only that is set to the minimum of all interfaces
1699  *
1700  * @chandef: the channel definition to tune to
1701  * @radar_enabled: whether radar detection is enabled
1702  *
1703  * @long_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "long" frame
1704  *	(a frame not RTS protected), called "dot11LongRetryLimit" in 802.11,
1705  *	but actually means the number of transmissions not the number of retries
1706  * @short_frame_max_tx_count: Maximum number of transmissions for a "short"
1707  *	frame, called "dot11ShortRetryLimit" in 802.11, but actually means the
1708  *	number of transmissions not the number of retries
1709  *
1710  * @smps_mode: spatial multiplexing powersave mode; note that
1711  *	%IEEE80211_SMPS_STATIC is used when the device is not
1712  *	configured for an HT channel.
1713  *	Note that this is only valid if channel contexts are not used,
1714  *	otherwise each channel context has the number of chains listed.
1715  */
1716 struct ieee80211_conf {
1717 	u32 flags;
1718 	int power_level, dynamic_ps_timeout;
1719 
1720 	u16 listen_interval;
1721 	u8 ps_dtim_period;
1722 
1723 	u8 long_frame_max_tx_count, short_frame_max_tx_count;
1724 
1725 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1726 	bool radar_enabled;
1727 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
1728 };
1729 
1730 /**
1731  * struct ieee80211_channel_switch - holds the channel switch data
1732  *
1733  * The information provided in this structure is required for channel switch
1734  * operation.
1735  *
1736  * @timestamp: value in microseconds of the 64-bit Time Synchronization
1737  *	Function (TSF) timer when the frame containing the channel switch
1738  *	announcement was received. This is simply the rx.mactime parameter
1739  *	the driver passed into mac80211.
1740  * @device_timestamp: arbitrary timestamp for the device, this is the
1741  *	rx.device_timestamp parameter the driver passed to mac80211.
1742  * @block_tx: Indicates whether transmission must be blocked before the
1743  *	scheduled channel switch, as indicated by the AP.
1744  * @chandef: the new channel to switch to
1745  * @count: the number of TBTT's until the channel switch event
1746  * @delay: maximum delay between the time the AP transmitted the last beacon in
1747   *	current channel and the expected time of the first beacon in the new
1748   *	channel, expressed in TU.
1749  */
1750 struct ieee80211_channel_switch {
1751 	u64 timestamp;
1752 	u32 device_timestamp;
1753 	bool block_tx;
1754 	struct cfg80211_chan_def chandef;
1755 	u8 count;
1756 	u32 delay;
1757 };
1758 
1759 /**
1760  * enum ieee80211_vif_flags - virtual interface flags
1761  *
1762  * @IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER: the device performs beacon filtering
1763  *	on this virtual interface to avoid unnecessary CPU wakeups
1764  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI: the device can do connection quality
1765  *	monitoring on this virtual interface -- i.e. it can monitor
1766  *	connection quality related parameters, such as the RSSI level and
1767  *	provide notifications if configured trigger levels are reached.
1768  * @IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD: The device can do U-APSD for this
1769  *	interface. This flag should be set during interface addition,
1770  *	but may be set/cleared as late as authentication to an AP. It is
1771  *	only valid for managed/station mode interfaces.
1772  * @IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE: request to handle NOA attributes
1773  *	and send P2P_PS notification to the driver if NOA changed, even
1774  *	this is not pure P2P vif.
1775  * @IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE: The driver indicates that EML operation is
1776  *      enabled for the interface.
1777  */
1778 enum ieee80211_vif_flags {
1779 	IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER		= BIT(0),
1780 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI		= BIT(1),
1781 	IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD		= BIT(2),
1782 	IEEE80211_VIF_GET_NOA_UPDATE		= BIT(3),
1783 	IEEE80211_VIF_EML_ACTIVE	        = BIT(4),
1784 };
1785 
1786 
1787 /**
1788  * enum ieee80211_offload_flags - virtual interface offload flags
1789  *
1790  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED: tx encapsulation offload is enabled
1791  *	The driver supports sending frames passed as 802.3 frames by mac80211.
1792  *	It must also support sending 802.11 packets for the same interface.
1793  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR: support 4-address mode encapsulation offload
1794  * @IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED: rx encapsulation offload is enabled
1795  *	The driver supports passing received 802.11 frames as 802.3 frames to
1796  *	mac80211.
1797  */
1798 
1799 enum ieee80211_offload_flags {
1800 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_ENABLED		= BIT(0),
1801 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_ENCAP_4ADDR		= BIT(1),
1802 	IEEE80211_OFFLOAD_DECAP_ENABLED		= BIT(2),
1803 };
1804 
1805 /**
1806  * struct ieee80211_vif_cfg - interface configuration
1807  * @assoc: association status
1808  * @ibss_joined: indicates whether this station is part of an IBSS or not
1809  * @ibss_creator: indicates if a new IBSS network is being created
1810  * @ps: power-save mode (STA only). This flag is NOT affected by
1811  *	offchannel/dynamic_ps operations.
1812  * @aid: association ID number, valid only when @assoc is true
1813  * @eml_cap: EML capabilities as described in P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001j.
1814  * @eml_med_sync_delay: Medium Synchronization delay as described in
1815  *	P802.11be_D4.1 Figure 9-1001i.
1816  * @mld_capa_op: MLD Capabilities and Operations per P802.11be_D4.1
1817  *	Figure 9-1001k
1818  * @arp_addr_list: List of IPv4 addresses for hardware ARP filtering. The
1819  *	may filter ARP queries targeted for other addresses than listed here.
1820  *	The driver must allow ARP queries targeted for all address listed here
1821  *	to pass through. An empty list implies no ARP queries need to pass.
1822  * @arp_addr_cnt: Number of addresses currently on the list. Note that this
1823  *	may be larger than %IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN (the arp_addr_list
1824  *	array size), it's up to the driver what to do in that case.
1825  * @ssid: The SSID of the current vif. Valid in AP and IBSS mode.
1826  * @ssid_len: Length of SSID given in @ssid.
1827  * @s1g: BSS is S1G BSS (affects Association Request format).
1828  * @idle: This interface is idle. There's also a global idle flag in the
1829  *	hardware config which may be more appropriate depending on what
1830  *	your driver/device needs to do.
1831  * @ap_addr: AP MLD address, or BSSID for non-MLO connections
1832  *	(station mode only)
1833  */
1834 struct ieee80211_vif_cfg {
1835 	/* association related data */
1836 	bool assoc, ibss_joined;
1837 	bool ibss_creator;
1838 	bool ps;
1839 	u16 aid;
1840 	u16 eml_cap;
1841 	u16 eml_med_sync_delay;
1842 	u16 mld_capa_op;
1843 
1844 	__be32 arp_addr_list[IEEE80211_BSS_ARP_ADDR_LIST_LEN];
1845 	int arp_addr_cnt;
1846 	u8 ssid[IEEE80211_MAX_SSID_LEN];
1847 	size_t ssid_len;
1848 	bool s1g;
1849 	bool idle;
1850 	u8 ap_addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1851 };
1852 
1853 #define IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS 8
1854 
1855 /**
1856  * struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm - negotiated TID to link map info
1857  *
1858  * @downlink: bitmap of active links per TID for downlink, or 0 if mapping for
1859  *	this TID is not included.
1860  * @uplink: bitmap of active links per TID for uplink, or 0 if mapping for this
1861  *	TID is not included.
1862  * @valid: info is valid or not.
1863  */
1864 struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm {
1865 	u16 downlink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1866 	u16 uplink[IEEE80211_TTLM_NUM_TIDS];
1867 	bool valid;
1868 };
1869 
1870 /**
1871  * enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res - return value for negotiated TTLM handling
1872  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT: accept the request
1873  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT: reject the request
1874  * @NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED: reject and suggest a new mapping
1875  */
1876 enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res {
1877 	NEG_TTLM_RES_ACCEPT,
1878 	NEG_TTLM_RES_REJECT,
1879 	NEG_TTLM_RES_SUGGEST_PREFERRED
1880 };
1881 
1882 /**
1883  * struct ieee80211_vif - per-interface data
1884  *
1885  * Data in this structure is continually present for driver
1886  * use during the life of a virtual interface.
1887  *
1888  * @type: type of this virtual interface
1889  * @cfg: vif configuration, see &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg
1890  * @bss_conf: BSS configuration for this interface, either our own
1891  *	or the BSS we're associated to
1892  * @link_conf: in case of MLD, the per-link BSS configuration,
1893  *	indexed by link ID
1894  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1895  * @active_links: The bitmap of active links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1896  *	The driver shouldn't change this directly, but use the
1897  *	API calls meant for that purpose.
1898  * @dormant_links: bitmap of valid but disabled links, or 0 for non-MLO.
1899  *	Must be a subset of valid_links.
1900  * @suspended_links: subset of dormant_links representing links that are
1901  *	suspended.
1902  *	0 for non-MLO.
1903  * @neg_ttlm: negotiated TID to link mapping info.
1904  *	see &struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm.
1905  * @addr: address of this interface
1906  * @p2p: indicates whether this AP or STA interface is a p2p
1907  *	interface, i.e. a GO or p2p-sta respectively
1908  * @netdev_features: tx netdev features supported by the hardware for this
1909  *	vif. mac80211 initializes this to hw->netdev_features, and the driver
1910  *	can mask out specific tx features. mac80211 will handle software fixup
1911  *	for masked offloads (GSO, CSUM)
1912  * @driver_flags: flags/capabilities the driver has for this interface,
1913  *	these need to be set (or cleared) when the interface is added
1914  *	or, if supported by the driver, the interface type is changed
1915  *	at runtime, mac80211 will never touch this field
1916  * @offload_flags: hardware offload capabilities/flags for this interface.
1917  *	These are initialized by mac80211 before calling .add_interface,
1918  *	.change_interface or .update_vif_offload and updated by the driver
1919  *	within these ops, based on supported features or runtime change
1920  *	restrictions.
1921  * @hw_queue: hardware queue for each AC
1922  * @cab_queue: content-after-beacon (DTIM beacon really) queue, AP mode only
1923  * @debugfs_dir: debugfs dentry, can be used by drivers to create own per
1924  *	interface debug files. Note that it will be NULL for the virtual
1925  *	monitor interface (if that is requested.)
1926  * @probe_req_reg: probe requests should be reported to mac80211 for this
1927  *	interface.
1928  * @rx_mcast_action_reg: multicast Action frames should be reported to mac80211
1929  *	for this interface.
1930  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
1931  *	sizeof(void \*).
1932  * @txq: the multicast data TX queue
1933  * @offload_flags: 802.3 -> 802.11 enapsulation offload flags, see
1934  *	&enum ieee80211_offload_flags.
1935  * @mbssid_tx_vif: Pointer to the transmitting interface if MBSSID is enabled.
1936  */
1937 struct ieee80211_vif {
1938 	enum nl80211_iftype type;
1939 	struct ieee80211_vif_cfg cfg;
1940 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf bss_conf;
1941 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf __rcu *link_conf[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
1942 	u16 valid_links, active_links, dormant_links, suspended_links;
1943 	struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm neg_ttlm;
1944 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN] __aligned(2);
1945 	bool p2p;
1946 
1947 	u8 cab_queue;
1948 	u8 hw_queue[IEEE80211_NUM_ACS];
1949 
1950 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq;
1951 
1952 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
1953 	u32 driver_flags;
1954 	u32 offload_flags;
1955 
1956 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
1957 	struct dentry *debugfs_dir;
1958 #endif
1959 
1960 	bool probe_req_reg;
1961 	bool rx_mcast_action_reg;
1962 
1963 	struct ieee80211_vif *mbssid_tx_vif;
1964 
1965 	/* must be last */
1966 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
1967 };
1968 
1969 /**
1970  * ieee80211_vif_usable_links - Return the usable links for the vif
1971  * @vif: the vif for which the usable links are requested
1972  * Return: the usable link bitmap
1973  */
1974 static inline u16 ieee80211_vif_usable_links(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1975 {
1976 	return vif->valid_links & ~vif->dormant_links;
1977 }
1978 
1979 /**
1980  * ieee80211_vif_is_mld - Returns true iff the vif is an MLD one
1981  * @vif: the vif
1982  * Return: %true if the vif is an MLD, %false otherwise.
1983  */
1984 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mld(const struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1985 {
1986 	/* valid_links != 0 indicates this vif is an MLD */
1987 	return vif->valid_links != 0;
1988 }
1989 
1990 #define for_each_vif_active_link(vif, link, link_id)				\
1991 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((vif)->link_conf); link_id++)	\
1992 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
1993 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
1994 		    (link = link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)))
1995 
1996 static inline bool ieee80211_vif_is_mesh(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
1997 {
1998 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_MESH
1999 	return vif->type == NL80211_IFTYPE_MESH_POINT;
2000 #endif
2001 	return false;
2002 }
2003 
2004 /**
2005  * wdev_to_ieee80211_vif - return a vif struct from a wdev
2006  * @wdev: the wdev to get the vif for
2007  *
2008  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2009  * (like the vendor commands) that get a wdev.
2010  *
2011  * Note that this function may return %NULL if the given wdev isn't
2012  * associated with a vif that the driver knows about (e.g. monitor
2013  * or AP_VLAN interfaces.)
2014  */
2015 struct ieee80211_vif *wdev_to_ieee80211_vif(struct wireless_dev *wdev);
2016 
2017 /**
2018  * ieee80211_vif_to_wdev - return a wdev struct from a vif
2019  * @vif: the vif to get the wdev for
2020  *
2021  * This can be used by mac80211 drivers with direct cfg80211 APIs
2022  * (like the vendor commands) that needs to get the wdev for a vif.
2023  * This can also be useful to get the netdev associated to a vif.
2024  */
2025 struct wireless_dev *ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
2026 
2027 static inline bool lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
2028 {
2029 	return lockdep_is_held(&ieee80211_vif_to_wdev(vif)->wiphy->mtx);
2030 }
2031 
2032 #define link_conf_dereference_protected(vif, link_id)		\
2033 	rcu_dereference_protected((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2034 				  lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2035 
2036 #define link_conf_dereference_check(vif, link_id)		\
2037 	rcu_dereference_check((vif)->link_conf[link_id],	\
2038 			      lockdep_vif_wiphy_mutex_held(vif))
2039 
2040 /**
2041  * enum ieee80211_key_flags - key flags
2042  *
2043  * These flags are used for communication about keys between the driver
2044  * and mac80211, with the @flags parameter of &struct ieee80211_key_conf.
2045  *
2046  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV: This flag should be set by the
2047  *	driver to indicate that it requires IV generation for this
2048  *	particular key. Setting this flag does not necessarily mean that SKBs
2049  *	will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or MIC.
2050  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC: This flag should be set by
2051  *	the driver for a TKIP key if it requires Michael MIC
2052  *	generation in software.
2053  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE: Set by mac80211, this flag indicates
2054  *	that the key is pairwise rather then a shared key.
2055  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX: This flag should be set by the driver for a
2056  *	CCMP/GCMP key if it requires CCMP/GCMP encryption of management frames
2057  *	(MFP) to be done in software.
2058  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver
2059  *	if space should be prepared for the IV, but the IV
2060  *	itself should not be generated. Do not set together with
2061  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV on the same key. Setting this flag does
2062  *	not necessarily mean that SKBs will have sufficient tailroom for ICV or
2063  *	MIC.
2064  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT: This key will be used to decrypt received
2065  *	management frames. The flag can help drivers that have a hardware
2066  *	crypto implementation that doesn't deal with management frames
2067  *	properly by allowing them to not upload the keys to hardware and
2068  *	fall back to software crypto. Note that this flag deals only with
2069  *	RX, if your crypto engine can't deal with TX you can also set the
2070  *	%IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX flag to encrypt such frames in SW.
2071  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT: This flag should be set by the
2072  *	driver for a CCMP/GCMP key to indicate that is requires IV generation
2073  *	only for management frames (MFP).
2074  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM: This flag should be set by the
2075  *	driver for a key to indicate that sufficient tailroom must always
2076  *	be reserved for ICV or MIC, even when HW encryption is enabled.
2077  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE: This flag should be set by the driver for
2078  *	a TKIP key if it only requires MIC space. Do not set together with
2079  *	@IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC on the same key.
2080  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX: Key needs explicit Tx activation.
2081  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE: This flag should be set by the driver
2082  *	for a AES_CMAC key to indicate that it requires sequence number
2083  *	generation only
2084  * @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU: SPP A-MSDUs can be used with this key
2085  *	(set by mac80211 from the sta->spp_amsdu flag)
2086  */
2087 enum ieee80211_key_flags {
2088 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV_MGMT	= BIT(0),
2089 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV		= BIT(1),
2090 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIC	= BIT(2),
2091 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PAIRWISE		= BIT(3),
2092 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SW_MGMT_TX		= BIT(4),
2093 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_IV_SPACE		= BIT(5),
2094 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RX_MGMT		= BIT(6),
2095 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_RESERVE_TAILROOM	= BIT(7),
2096 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_PUT_MIC_SPACE	= BIT(8),
2097 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_NO_AUTO_TX		= BIT(9),
2098 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_MMIE	= BIT(10),
2099 	IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_SPP_AMSDU		= BIT(11),
2100 };
2101 
2102 /**
2103  * struct ieee80211_key_conf - key information
2104  *
2105  * This key information is given by mac80211 to the driver by
2106  * the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops.
2107  *
2108  * @hw_key_idx: To be set by the driver, this is the key index the driver
2109  *	wants to be given when a frame is transmitted and needs to be
2110  *	encrypted in hardware.
2111  * @cipher: The key's cipher suite selector.
2112  * @tx_pn: PN used for TX keys, may be used by the driver as well if it
2113  *	needs to do software PN assignment by itself (e.g. due to TSO)
2114  * @flags: key flags, see &enum ieee80211_key_flags.
2115  * @keyidx: the key index (0-3)
2116  * @keylen: key material length
2117  * @key: key material. For ALG_TKIP the key is encoded as a 256-bit (32 byte)
2118  * 	data block:
2119  * 	- Temporal Encryption Key (128 bits)
2120  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Tx MIC Key (64 bits)
2121  * 	- Temporal Authenticator Rx MIC Key (64 bits)
2122  * @icv_len: The ICV length for this key type
2123  * @iv_len: The IV length for this key type
2124  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, or -1 for non-MLO or pairwise keys
2125  */
2126 struct ieee80211_key_conf {
2127 	atomic64_t tx_pn;
2128 	u32 cipher;
2129 	u8 icv_len;
2130 	u8 iv_len;
2131 	u8 hw_key_idx;
2132 	s8 keyidx;
2133 	u16 flags;
2134 	s8 link_id;
2135 	u8 keylen;
2136 	u8 key[];
2137 };
2138 
2139 #define IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN	16
2140 
2141 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV16(pn) ((u16)(pn & 0xffff))
2142 #define TKIP_PN_TO_IV32(pn) ((u32)((pn >> 16) & 0xffffffff))
2143 
2144 /**
2145  * struct ieee80211_key_seq - key sequence counter
2146  *
2147  * @tkip: TKIP data, containing IV32 and IV16 in host byte order
2148  * @ccmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2149  *	reverse order than in packet)
2150  * @aes_cmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2151  *	reverse order than in packet)
2152  * @aes_gmac: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2153  *	reverse order than in packet)
2154  * @gcmp: PN data, most significant byte first (big endian,
2155  *	reverse order than in packet)
2156  * @hw: data for HW-only (e.g. cipher scheme) keys
2157  */
2158 struct ieee80211_key_seq {
2159 	union {
2160 		struct {
2161 			u32 iv32;
2162 			u16 iv16;
2163 		} tkip;
2164 		struct {
2165 			u8 pn[6];
2166 		} ccmp;
2167 		struct {
2168 			u8 pn[6];
2169 		} aes_cmac;
2170 		struct {
2171 			u8 pn[6];
2172 		} aes_gmac;
2173 		struct {
2174 			u8 pn[6];
2175 		} gcmp;
2176 		struct {
2177 			u8 seq[IEEE80211_MAX_PN_LEN];
2178 			u8 seq_len;
2179 		} hw;
2180 	};
2181 };
2182 
2183 /**
2184  * enum set_key_cmd - key command
2185  *
2186  * Used with the set_key() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2187  * indicates whether a key is being removed or added.
2188  *
2189  * @SET_KEY: a key is set
2190  * @DISABLE_KEY: a key must be disabled
2191  */
2192 enum set_key_cmd {
2193 	SET_KEY, DISABLE_KEY,
2194 };
2195 
2196 /**
2197  * enum ieee80211_sta_state - station state
2198  *
2199  * @IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST: station doesn't exist at all,
2200  *	this is a special state for add/remove transitions
2201  * @IEEE80211_STA_NONE: station exists without special state
2202  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTH: station is authenticated
2203  * @IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC: station is associated
2204  * @IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED: station is authorized (802.1X)
2205  */
2206 enum ieee80211_sta_state {
2207 	/* NOTE: These need to be ordered correctly! */
2208 	IEEE80211_STA_NOTEXIST,
2209 	IEEE80211_STA_NONE,
2210 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTH,
2211 	IEEE80211_STA_ASSOC,
2212 	IEEE80211_STA_AUTHORIZED,
2213 };
2214 
2215 /**
2216  * enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth - station RX bandwidth
2217  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20: station can only receive 20 MHz
2218  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40: station can receive up to 40 MHz
2219  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80: station can receive up to 80 MHz
2220  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160: station can receive up to 160 MHz
2221  *	(including 80+80 MHz)
2222  * @IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320: station can receive up to 320 MHz
2223  *
2224  * Implementation note: 20 must be zero to be initialized
2225  *	correctly, the values must be sorted.
2226  */
2227 enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth {
2228 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_20 = 0,
2229 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_40,
2230 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_80,
2231 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_160,
2232 	IEEE80211_STA_RX_BW_320,
2233 };
2234 
2235 /**
2236  * struct ieee80211_sta_rates - station rate selection table
2237  *
2238  * @rcu_head: RCU head used for freeing the table on update
2239  * @rate: transmit rates/flags to be used by default.
2240  *	Overriding entries per-packet is possible by using cb tx control.
2241  */
2242 struct ieee80211_sta_rates {
2243 	struct rcu_head rcu_head;
2244 	struct {
2245 		s8 idx;
2246 		u8 count;
2247 		u8 count_cts;
2248 		u8 count_rts;
2249 		u16 flags;
2250 	} rate[IEEE80211_TX_RATE_TABLE_SIZE];
2251 };
2252 
2253 /**
2254  * struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr - station txpower configuration
2255  *
2256  * Used to configure txpower for station.
2257  *
2258  * @power: indicates the tx power, in dBm, to be used when sending data frames
2259  *	to the STA.
2260  * @type: In particular if TPC %type is NL80211_TX_POWER_LIMITED then tx power
2261  *	will be less than or equal to specified from userspace, whereas if TPC
2262  *	%type is NL80211_TX_POWER_AUTOMATIC then it indicates default tx power.
2263  *	NL80211_TX_POWER_FIXED is not a valid configuration option for
2264  *	per peer TPC.
2265  */
2266 struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr {
2267 	s16 power;
2268 	enum nl80211_tx_power_setting type;
2269 };
2270 
2271 /**
2272  * struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates - info that is aggregated from active links
2273  *
2274  * Used for any per-link data that needs to be aggregated and updated in the
2275  * main &struct ieee80211_sta when updated or the active links change.
2276  *
2277  * @max_amsdu_len: indicates the maximal length of an A-MSDU in bytes.
2278  *	This field is always valid for packets with a VHT preamble.
2279  *	For packets with a HT preamble, additional limits apply:
2280  *
2281  *	* If the skb is transmitted as part of a BA agreement, the
2282  *	  A-MSDU maximal size is min(max_amsdu_len, 4065) bytes.
2283  *	* If the skb is not part of a BA agreement, the A-MSDU maximal
2284  *	  size is min(max_amsdu_len, 7935) bytes.
2285  *
2286  * Both additional HT limits must be enforced by the low level
2287  * driver. This is defined by the spec (IEEE 802.11-2012 section
2288  * 8.3.2.2 NOTE 2).
2289  * @max_rc_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes recommended by rate control.
2290  * @max_tid_amsdu_len: Maximum A-MSDU size in bytes for this TID
2291  */
2292 struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates {
2293 	u16 max_amsdu_len;
2294 
2295 	u16 max_rc_amsdu_len;
2296 	u16 max_tid_amsdu_len[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS];
2297 };
2298 
2299 /**
2300  * struct ieee80211_link_sta - station Link specific info
2301  * All link specific info for a STA link for a non MLD STA(single)
2302  * or a MLD STA(multiple entries) are stored here.
2303  *
2304  * @sta: reference to owning STA
2305  * @addr: MAC address of the Link STA. For non-MLO STA this is same as the addr
2306  *	in ieee80211_sta. For MLO Link STA this addr can be same or different
2307  *	from addr in ieee80211_sta (representing MLD STA addr)
2308  * @link_id: the link ID for this link STA (0 for deflink)
2309  * @smps_mode: current SMPS mode (off, static or dynamic)
2310  * @supp_rates: Bitmap of supported rates
2311  * @ht_cap: HT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2312  * @vht_cap: VHT capabilities of this STA; restricted to our own capabilities
2313  * @he_cap: HE capabilities of this STA
2314  * @he_6ghz_capa: on 6 GHz, holds the HE 6 GHz band capabilities
2315  * @eht_cap: EHT capabilities of this STA
2316  * @agg: per-link data for multi-link aggregation
2317  * @bandwidth: current bandwidth the station can receive with
2318  * @rx_nss: in HT/VHT, the maximum number of spatial streams the
2319  *	station can receive at the moment, changed by operating mode
2320  *	notifications and capabilities. The value is only valid after
2321  *	the station moves to associated state.
2322  * @txpwr: the station tx power configuration
2323  *
2324  */
2325 struct ieee80211_link_sta {
2326 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2327 
2328 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2329 	u8 link_id;
2330 	enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode;
2331 
2332 	u32 supp_rates[NUM_NL80211_BANDS];
2333 	struct ieee80211_sta_ht_cap ht_cap;
2334 	struct ieee80211_sta_vht_cap vht_cap;
2335 	struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap he_cap;
2336 	struct ieee80211_he_6ghz_capa he_6ghz_capa;
2337 	struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap eht_cap;
2338 
2339 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates agg;
2340 
2341 	u8 rx_nss;
2342 	enum ieee80211_sta_rx_bandwidth bandwidth;
2343 	struct ieee80211_sta_txpwr txpwr;
2344 };
2345 
2346 /**
2347  * struct ieee80211_sta - station table entry
2348  *
2349  * A station table entry represents a station we are possibly
2350  * communicating with. Since stations are RCU-managed in
2351  * mac80211, any ieee80211_sta pointer you get access to must
2352  * either be protected by rcu_read_lock() explicitly or implicitly,
2353  * or you must take good care to not use such a pointer after a
2354  * call to your sta_remove callback that removed it.
2355  * This also represents the MLD STA in case of MLO association
2356  * and holds pointers to various link STA's
2357  *
2358  * @addr: MAC address
2359  * @aid: AID we assigned to the station if we're an AP
2360  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximal amount of frames in a single AMPDU
2361  *	that this station is allowed to transmit to us.
2362  *	Can be modified by driver.
2363  * @wme: indicates whether the STA supports QoS/WME (if local devices does,
2364  *	otherwise always false)
2365  * @drv_priv: data area for driver use, will always be aligned to
2366  *	sizeof(void \*), size is determined in hw information.
2367  * @uapsd_queues: bitmap of queues configured for uapsd. Only valid
2368  *	if wme is supported. The bits order is like in
2369  *	IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_*.
2370  * @max_sp: max Service Period. Only valid if wme is supported.
2371  * @rates: rate control selection table
2372  * @tdls: indicates whether the STA is a TDLS peer
2373  * @tdls_initiator: indicates the STA is an initiator of the TDLS link. Only
2374  *	valid if the STA is a TDLS peer in the first place.
2375  * @mfp: indicates whether the STA uses management frame protection or not.
2376  * @mlo: indicates whether the STA is MLO station.
2377  * @max_amsdu_subframes: indicates the maximal number of MSDUs in a single
2378  *	A-MSDU. Taken from the Extended Capabilities element. 0 means
2379  *	unlimited.
2380  * @cur: currently valid data as aggregated from the active links
2381  *	For non MLO STA it will point to the deflink data. For MLO STA
2382  *	ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates() must be called to update it.
2383  * @support_p2p_ps: indicates whether the STA supports P2P PS mechanism or not.
2384  * @txq: per-TID data TX queues; note that the last entry (%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS)
2385  *	is used for non-data frames
2386  * @deflink: This holds the default link STA information, for non MLO STA all link
2387  *	specific STA information is accessed through @deflink or through
2388  *	link[0] which points to address of @deflink. For MLO Link STA
2389  *	the first added link STA will point to deflink.
2390  * @link: reference to Link Sta entries. For Non MLO STA, except 1st link,
2391  *	i.e link[0] all links would be assigned to NULL by default and
2392  *	would access link information via @deflink or link[0]. For MLO
2393  *	STA, first link STA being added will point its link pointer to
2394  *	@deflink address and remaining would be allocated and the address
2395  *	would be assigned to link[link_id] where link_id is the id assigned
2396  *	by the AP.
2397  * @valid_links: bitmap of valid links, or 0 for non-MLO
2398  * @spp_amsdu: indicates whether the STA uses SPP A-MSDU or not.
2399  */
2400 struct ieee80211_sta {
2401 	u8 addr[ETH_ALEN];
2402 	u16 aid;
2403 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2404 	bool wme;
2405 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2406 	u8 max_sp;
2407 	struct ieee80211_sta_rates __rcu *rates;
2408 	bool tdls;
2409 	bool tdls_initiator;
2410 	bool mfp;
2411 	bool mlo;
2412 	bool spp_amsdu;
2413 	u8 max_amsdu_subframes;
2414 
2415 	struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates *cur;
2416 
2417 	bool support_p2p_ps;
2418 
2419 	struct ieee80211_txq *txq[IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS + 1];
2420 
2421 	u16 valid_links;
2422 	struct ieee80211_link_sta deflink;
2423 	struct ieee80211_link_sta __rcu *link[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS];
2424 
2425 	/* must be last */
2426 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2427 };
2428 
2429 #ifdef CONFIG_LOCKDEP
2430 bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
2431 #else
2432 static inline bool lockdep_sta_mutex_held(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta)
2433 {
2434 	return true;
2435 }
2436 #endif
2437 
2438 #define link_sta_dereference_protected(sta, link_id)		\
2439 	rcu_dereference_protected((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2440 				  lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2441 
2442 #define link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)		\
2443 	rcu_dereference_check((sta)->link[link_id],		\
2444 			      lockdep_sta_mutex_held(sta))
2445 
2446 #define for_each_sta_active_link(vif, sta, link_sta, link_id)			\
2447 	for (link_id = 0; link_id < ARRAY_SIZE((sta)->link); link_id++)		\
2448 		if ((!(vif)->active_links ||					\
2449 		     (vif)->active_links & BIT(link_id)) &&			\
2450 		    ((link_sta) = link_sta_dereference_check(sta, link_id)))
2451 
2452 /**
2453  * enum sta_notify_cmd - sta notify command
2454  *
2455  * Used with the sta_notify() callback in &struct ieee80211_ops, this
2456  * indicates if an associated station made a power state transition.
2457  *
2458  * @STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP: a station is now sleeping
2459  * @STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE: a sleeping station woke up
2460  */
2461 enum sta_notify_cmd {
2462 	STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP, STA_NOTIFY_AWAKE,
2463 };
2464 
2465 /**
2466  * struct ieee80211_tx_control - TX control data
2467  *
2468  * @sta: station table entry, this sta pointer may be NULL and
2469  * 	it is not allowed to copy the pointer, due to RCU.
2470  */
2471 struct ieee80211_tx_control {
2472 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2473 };
2474 
2475 /**
2476  * struct ieee80211_txq - Software intermediate tx queue
2477  *
2478  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
2479  * @sta: station table entry, %NULL for per-vif queue
2480  * @tid: the TID for this queue (unused for per-vif queue),
2481  *	%IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS for non-data (if enabled)
2482  * @ac: the AC for this queue
2483  * @drv_priv: driver private area, sized by hw->txq_data_size
2484  *
2485  * The driver can obtain packets from this queue by calling
2486  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue().
2487  */
2488 struct ieee80211_txq {
2489 	struct ieee80211_vif *vif;
2490 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
2491 	u8 tid;
2492 	u8 ac;
2493 
2494 	/* must be last */
2495 	u8 drv_priv[] __aligned(sizeof(void *));
2496 };
2497 
2498 /**
2499  * enum ieee80211_hw_flags - hardware flags
2500  *
2501  * These flags are used to indicate hardware capabilities to
2502  * the stack. Generally, flags here should have their meaning
2503  * done in a way that the simplest hardware doesn't need setting
2504  * any particular flags. There are some exceptions to this rule,
2505  * however, so you are advised to review these flags carefully.
2506  *
2507  * @IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL:
2508  *	The hardware or firmware includes rate control, and cannot be
2509  *	controlled by the stack. As such, no rate control algorithm
2510  *	should be instantiated, and the TX rate reported to userspace
2511  *	will be taken from the TX status instead of the rate control
2512  *	algorithm.
2513  *	Note that this requires that the driver implement a number of
2514  *	callbacks so it has the correct information, it needs to have
2515  *	the @set_rts_threshold callback and must look at the BSS config
2516  *	@use_cts_prot for G/N protection, @use_short_slot for slot
2517  *	timing in 2.4 GHz and @use_short_preamble for preambles for
2518  *	CCK frames.
2519  *
2520  * @IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS:
2521  *	Indicates that received frames passed to the stack include
2522  *	the FCS at the end.
2523  *
2524  * @IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING:
2525  *	Some wireless LAN chipsets buffer broadcast/multicast frames
2526  *	for power saving stations in the hardware/firmware and others
2527  *	rely on the host system for such buffering. This option is used
2528  *	to configure the IEEE 802.11 upper layer to buffer broadcast and
2529  *	multicast frames when there are power saving stations so that
2530  *	the driver can fetch them with ieee80211_get_buffered_bc().
2531  *
2532  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC:
2533  *	Hardware can provide signal values but we don't know its units. We
2534  *	expect values between 0 and @max_signal.
2535  *	If possible please provide dB or dBm instead.
2536  *
2537  * @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM:
2538  *	Hardware gives signal values in dBm, decibel difference from
2539  *	one milliwatt. This is the preferred method since it is standardized
2540  *	between different devices. @max_signal does not need to be set.
2541  *
2542  * @IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT:
2543  * 	Hardware supports spectrum management defined in 802.11h
2544  * 	Measurement, Channel Switch, Quieting, TPC
2545  *
2546  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION:
2547  *	Hardware supports 11n A-MPDU aggregation.
2548  *
2549  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS:
2550  *	Hardware has power save support (i.e. can go to sleep).
2551  *
2552  * @IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK:
2553  *	Hardware requires nullfunc frame handling in stack, implies
2554  *	stack support for dynamic PS.
2555  *
2556  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS:
2557  *	Hardware has support for dynamic PS.
2558  *
2559  * @IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE:
2560  *	Hardware supports management frame protection (MFP, IEEE 802.11w).
2561  *
2562  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS:
2563  *	Hardware can provide ack status reports of Tx frames to
2564  *	the stack.
2565  *
2566  * @IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR:
2567  *	The hardware performs its own connection monitoring, including
2568  *	periodic keep-alives to the AP and probing the AP on beacon loss.
2569  *
2570  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC:
2571  *	This device needs to get data from beacon before association (i.e.
2572  *	dtim_period).
2573  *
2574  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK: The device's crypto engine supports
2575  *	per-station GTKs as used by IBSS RSN or during fast transition. If
2576  *	the device doesn't support per-station GTKs, but can be asked not
2577  *	to decrypt group addressed frames, then IBSS RSN support is still
2578  *	possible but software crypto will be used. Advertise the wiphy flag
2579  *	only in that case.
2580  *
2581  * @IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS: When operating in AP mode the device
2582  *	autonomously manages the PS status of connected stations. When
2583  *	this flag is set mac80211 will not trigger PS mode for connected
2584  *	stations based on the PM bit of incoming frames.
2585  *	Use ieee80211_start_ps()/ieee8021_end_ps() to manually configure
2586  *	the PS mode of connected stations.
2587  *
2588  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW: The device handles TX A-MPDU session
2589  *	setup strictly in HW. mac80211 should not attempt to do this in
2590  *	software.
2591  *
2592  * @IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF: The driver would like to be informed of
2593  *	a virtual monitor interface when monitor interfaces are the only
2594  *	active interfaces.
2595  *
2596  * @IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF: The driver would like for no wlanX to
2597  *	be created.  It is expected user-space will create vifs as
2598  *	desired (and thus have them named as desired).
2599  *
2600  * @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL: The driver wants to control which of the
2601  *	crypto algorithms can be done in software - so don't automatically
2602  *	try to fall back to it if hardware crypto fails, but do so only if
2603  *	the driver returns 1. This also forces the driver to advertise its
2604  *	supported cipher suites.
2605  *
2606  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT: The driver/hardware supports fast-xmit,
2607  *	this currently requires only the ability to calculate the duration
2608  *	for frames.
2609  *
2610  * @IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL: The driver wants to control per-interface
2611  *	queue mapping in order to use different queues (not just one per AC)
2612  *	for different virtual interfaces. See the doc section on HW queue
2613  *	control for more details.
2614  *
2615  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE: The driver supports using a rate
2616  *	selection table provided by the rate control algorithm.
2617  *
2618  * @IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF: Use the P2P Device address for any
2619  *	P2P Interface. This will be honoured even if more than one interface
2620  *	is supported.
2621  *
2622  * @IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY: Use sync timing from beacon frames
2623  *	only, to allow getting TBTT of a DTIM beacon.
2624  *
2625  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES: Hardware supports mixing HT/CCK rates
2626  *	and can cope with CCK rates in an aggregation session (e.g. by not
2627  *	using aggregation for such frames.)
2628  *
2629  * @IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA: Support 802.11h based channel-switch (CSA)
2630  *	for a single active channel while using channel contexts. When support
2631  *	is not enabled the default action is to disconnect when getting the
2632  *	CSA frame.
2633  *
2634  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS: The driver will never modify the payload
2635  *	or tailroom of TX skbs without copying them first.
2636  *
2637  * @IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS: The HW supports scanning on all bands
2638  *	in one command, mac80211 doesn't have to run separate scans per band.
2639  *
2640  * @IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW: The device/driver supports wider bandwidth
2641  *	than then BSS bandwidth for a TDLS link on the base channel.
2642  *
2643  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU: The driver supports receiving A-MSDUs
2644  *	within A-MPDU.
2645  *
2646  * @IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS: The device/driver provides TX status
2647  *	for sent beacons.
2648  *
2649  * @IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR: Hardware (or driver) requires that each
2650  *	station has a unique address, i.e. each station entry can be identified
2651  *	by just its MAC address; this prevents, for example, the same station
2652  *	from connecting to two virtual AP interfaces at the same time.
2653  *
2654  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER: Hardware (or driver) manages the
2655  *	reordering buffer internally, guaranteeing mac80211 receives frames in
2656  *	order and does not need to manage its own reorder buffer or BA session
2657  *	timeout.
2658  *
2659  * @IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS: The device uses RSS and thus requires parallel RX,
2660  *	which implies using per-CPU station statistics.
2661  *
2662  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU: Hardware (or driver) supports software aggregated
2663  *	A-MSDU frames. Requires software tx queueing and fast-xmit support.
2664  *	When not using minstrel/minstrel_ht rate control, the driver must
2665  *	limit the maximum A-MSDU size based on the current tx rate by setting
2666  *	max_rc_amsdu_len in struct ieee80211_sta.
2667  *
2668  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST: Hardware (or driver) supports sending frag_list
2669  *	skbs, needed for zero-copy software A-MSDU.
2670  *
2671  * @IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK: The driver (or firmware) reports low ack event
2672  *	by ieee80211_report_low_ack() based on its own algorithm. For such
2673  *	drivers, mac80211 packet loss mechanism will not be triggered and driver
2674  *	is completely depending on firmware event for station kickout.
2675  *
2676  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG: Hardware does fragmentation by itself.
2677  *	The stack will not do fragmentation.
2678  *	The callback for @set_frag_threshold should be set as well.
2679  *
2680  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA: Hardware supports buffer STA on
2681  *	TDLS links.
2682  *
2683  * @IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP: The driver requires the
2684  *	mgd_prepare_tx() callback to be called before transmission of a
2685  *	deauthentication frame in case the association was completed but no
2686  *	beacon was heard. This is required in multi-channel scenarios, where the
2687  *	virtual interface might not be given air time for the transmission of
2688  *	the frame, as it is not synced with the AP/P2P GO yet, and thus the
2689  *	deauthentication frame might not be transmitted.
2690  *
2691  * @IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP: The driver (or firmware) doesn't
2692  *	support QoS NDP for AP probing - that's most likely a driver bug.
2693  *
2694  * @IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ: use the TXQ for bufferable MMPDUs, this of
2695  *	course requires the driver to use TXQs to start with.
2696  *
2697  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW: (Hardware) rate control supports VHT
2698  *	extended NSS BW (dot11VHTExtendedNSSBWCapable). This flag will be set if
2699  *	the selected rate control algorithm sets %RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW
2700  *	but if the rate control is built-in then it must be set by the driver.
2701  *	See also the documentation for that flag.
2702  *
2703  * @IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ: use the extra non-TID per-station TXQ for all
2704  *	MMPDUs on station interfaces. This of course requires the driver to use
2705  *	TXQs to start with.
2706  *
2707  * @IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN: Driver does not report accurate A-MPDU
2708  *	length in tx status information
2709  *
2710  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2711  *
2712  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID: Hardware supports multi BSSID
2713  *	only for HE APs. Applies if @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID is set.
2714  *
2715  * @IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT: The card and driver is only
2716  *	aggregating MPDUs with the same keyid, allowing mac80211 to keep Tx
2717  *	A-MPDU sessions active while rekeying with Extended Key ID.
2718  *
2719  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports tx encapsulation
2720  *	offload
2721  *
2722  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD: Hardware supports rx decapsulation
2723  *	offload
2724  *
2725  * @IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP: Hardware supports concurrent rx
2726  *	decapsulation offload and passing raw 802.11 frames for monitor iface.
2727  *	If this is supported, the driver must pass both 802.3 frames for real
2728  *	usage and 802.11 frames with %RX_FLAG_ONLY_MONITOR set for monitor to
2729  *	the stack.
2730  *
2731  * @IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION: HW/driver has support for BSS color
2732  *	collision detection and doesn't need it in software.
2733  *
2734  * @IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX: Hardware/driver handles transmitting
2735  *	multicast frames on all links, mac80211 should not do that.
2736  *
2737  * @IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING: HW requires disabling puncturing in EHT
2738  *	and connecting with a lower bandwidth instead
2739  *
2740  * @NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS: number of hardware flags, used for sizing arrays
2741  */
2742 enum ieee80211_hw_flags {
2743 	IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL,
2744 	IEEE80211_HW_RX_INCLUDES_FCS,
2745 	IEEE80211_HW_HOST_BROADCAST_PS_BUFFERING,
2746 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC,
2747 	IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DBM,
2748 	IEEE80211_HW_NEED_DTIM_BEFORE_ASSOC,
2749 	IEEE80211_HW_SPECTRUM_MGMT,
2750 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_AGGREGATION,
2751 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS,
2752 	IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK,
2753 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS,
2754 	IEEE80211_HW_MFP_CAPABLE,
2755 	IEEE80211_HW_WANT_MONITOR_VIF,
2756 	IEEE80211_HW_NO_AUTO_VIF,
2757 	IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL,
2758 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORT_FAST_XMIT,
2759 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_TX_ACK_STATUS,
2760 	IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR,
2761 	IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL,
2762 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PER_STA_GTK,
2763 	IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS,
2764 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMPDU_SETUP_IN_HW,
2765 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RC_TABLE,
2766 	IEEE80211_HW_P2P_DEV_ADDR_FOR_INTF,
2767 	IEEE80211_HW_TIMING_BEACON_ONLY,
2768 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_HT_CCK_RATES,
2769 	IEEE80211_HW_CHANCTX_STA_CSA,
2770 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CLONED_SKBS,
2771 	IEEE80211_HW_SINGLE_SCAN_ON_ALL_BANDS,
2772 	IEEE80211_HW_TDLS_WIDER_BW,
2773 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_AMSDU_IN_AMPDU,
2774 	IEEE80211_HW_BEACON_TX_STATUS,
2775 	IEEE80211_HW_NEEDS_UNIQUE_STA_ADDR,
2776 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_REORDERING_BUFFER,
2777 	IEEE80211_HW_USES_RSS,
2778 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_AMSDU,
2779 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_FRAG_LIST,
2780 	IEEE80211_HW_REPORTS_LOW_ACK,
2781 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG,
2782 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TDLS_BUFFER_STA,
2783 	IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP,
2784 	IEEE80211_HW_DOESNT_SUPPORT_QOS_NDP,
2785 	IEEE80211_HW_BUFF_MMPDU_TXQ,
2786 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW,
2787 	IEEE80211_HW_STA_MMPDU_TXQ,
2788 	IEEE80211_HW_TX_STATUS_NO_AMPDU_LEN,
2789 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_MULTI_BSSID,
2790 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_ONLY_HE_MULTI_BSSID,
2791 	IEEE80211_HW_AMPDU_KEYBORDER_SUPPORT,
2792 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_ENCAP_OFFLOAD,
2793 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_RX_DECAP_OFFLOAD,
2794 	IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_CONC_MON_RX_DECAP,
2795 	IEEE80211_HW_DETECTS_COLOR_COLLISION,
2796 	IEEE80211_HW_MLO_MCAST_MULTI_LINK_TX,
2797 	IEEE80211_HW_DISALLOW_PUNCTURING,
2798 
2799 	/* keep last, obviously */
2800 	NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS
2801 };
2802 
2803 /**
2804  * struct ieee80211_hw - hardware information and state
2805  *
2806  * This structure contains the configuration and hardware
2807  * information for an 802.11 PHY.
2808  *
2809  * @wiphy: This points to the &struct wiphy allocated for this
2810  *	802.11 PHY. You must fill in the @perm_addr and @dev
2811  *	members of this structure using SET_IEEE80211_DEV()
2812  *	and SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(). Additionally, all supported
2813  *	bands (with channels, bitrates) are registered here.
2814  *
2815  * @conf: &struct ieee80211_conf, device configuration, don't use.
2816  *
2817  * @priv: pointer to private area that was allocated for driver use
2818  *	along with this structure.
2819  *
2820  * @flags: hardware flags, see &enum ieee80211_hw_flags.
2821  *
2822  * @extra_tx_headroom: headroom to reserve in each transmit skb
2823  *	for use by the driver (e.g. for transmit headers.)
2824  *
2825  * @extra_beacon_tailroom: tailroom to reserve in each beacon tx skb.
2826  *	Can be used by drivers to add extra IEs.
2827  *
2828  * @max_signal: Maximum value for signal (rssi) in RX information, used
2829  *	only when @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_UNSPEC or @IEEE80211_HW_SIGNAL_DB
2830  *
2831  * @max_listen_interval: max listen interval in units of beacon interval
2832  *	that HW supports
2833  *
2834  * @queues: number of available hardware transmit queues for
2835  *	data packets. WMM/QoS requires at least four, these
2836  *	queues need to have configurable access parameters.
2837  *
2838  * @rate_control_algorithm: rate control algorithm for this hardware.
2839  *	If unset (NULL), the default algorithm will be used. Must be
2840  *	set before calling ieee80211_register_hw().
2841  *
2842  * @vif_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2843  *	within &struct ieee80211_vif.
2844  * @sta_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2845  *	within &struct ieee80211_sta.
2846  * @chanctx_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2847  *	within &struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf.
2848  * @txq_data_size: size (in bytes) of the drv_priv data area
2849  *	within @struct ieee80211_txq.
2850  *
2851  * @max_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages the hw
2852  *	can handle.
2853  * @max_report_rates: maximum number of alternate rate retry stages
2854  *	the hw can report back.
2855  * @max_rate_tries: maximum number of tries for each stage
2856  *
2857  * @max_rx_aggregation_subframes: maximum buffer size (number of
2858  *	sub-frames) to be used for A-MPDU block ack receiver
2859  *	aggregation.
2860  *	This is only relevant if the device has restrictions on the
2861  *	number of subframes, if it relies on mac80211 to do reordering
2862  *	it shouldn't be set.
2863  *
2864  * @max_tx_aggregation_subframes: maximum number of subframes in an
2865  *	aggregate an HT/HE device will transmit. In HT AddBA we'll
2866  *	advertise a constant value of 64 as some older APs crash if
2867  *	the window size is smaller (an example is LinkSys WRT120N
2868  *	with FW v1.0.07 build 002 Jun 18 2012).
2869  *	For AddBA to HE capable peers this value will be used.
2870  *
2871  * @max_tx_fragments: maximum number of tx buffers per (A)-MSDU, sum
2872  *	of 1 + skb_shinfo(skb)->nr_frags for each skb in the frag_list.
2873  *
2874  * @offchannel_tx_hw_queue: HW queue ID to use for offchannel TX
2875  *	(if %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL is set)
2876  *
2877  * @radiotap_mcs_details: lists which MCS information can the HW
2878  *	reports, by default it is set to _MCS, _GI and _BW but doesn't
2879  *	include _FMT. Use %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_MCS_HAVE_\* values, only
2880  *	adding _BW is supported today.
2881  *
2882  * @radiotap_vht_details: lists which VHT MCS information the HW reports,
2883  *	the default is _GI | _BANDWIDTH.
2884  *	Use the %IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_VHT_KNOWN_\* values.
2885  *
2886  * @radiotap_timestamp: Information for the radiotap timestamp field; if the
2887  *	@units_pos member is set to a non-negative value then the timestamp
2888  *	field will be added and populated from the &struct ieee80211_rx_status
2889  *	device_timestamp.
2890  * @radiotap_timestamp.units_pos: Must be set to a combination of a
2891  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_UNIT_* and a
2892  *	IEEE80211_RADIOTAP_TIMESTAMP_SPOS_* value.
2893  * @radiotap_timestamp.accuracy: If non-negative, fills the accuracy in the
2894  *	radiotap field and the accuracy known flag will be set.
2895  *
2896  * @netdev_features: netdev features to be set in each netdev created
2897  *	from this HW. Note that not all features are usable with mac80211,
2898  *	other features will be rejected during HW registration.
2899  *
2900  * @uapsd_queues: This bitmap is included in (re)association frame to indicate
2901  *	for each access category if it is uAPSD trigger-enabled and delivery-
2902  *	enabled. Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_AC_* to set this bitmap.
2903  *	Each bit corresponds to different AC. Value '1' in specific bit means
2904  *	that corresponding AC is both trigger- and delivery-enabled. '0' means
2905  *	neither enabled.
2906  *
2907  * @uapsd_max_sp_len: maximum number of total buffered frames the WMM AP may
2908  *	deliver to a WMM STA during any Service Period triggered by the WMM STA.
2909  *	Use IEEE80211_WMM_IE_STA_QOSINFO_SP_* for correct values.
2910  *
2911  * @max_nan_de_entries: maximum number of NAN DE functions supported by the
2912  *	device.
2913  *
2914  * @tx_sk_pacing_shift: Pacing shift to set on TCP sockets when frames from
2915  *	them are encountered. The default should typically not be changed,
2916  *	unless the driver has good reasons for needing more buffers.
2917  *
2918  * @weight_multiplier: Driver specific airtime weight multiplier used while
2919  *	refilling deficit of each TXQ.
2920  *
2921  * @max_mtu: the max mtu could be set.
2922  *
2923  * @tx_power_levels: a list of power levels supported by the wifi hardware.
2924  * 	The power levels can be specified either as integer or fractions.
2925  * 	The power level at idx 0 shall be the maximum positive power level.
2926  *
2927  * @max_txpwr_levels_idx: the maximum valid idx of 'tx_power_levels' list.
2928  */
2929 struct ieee80211_hw {
2930 	struct ieee80211_conf conf;
2931 	struct wiphy *wiphy;
2932 	const char *rate_control_algorithm;
2933 	void *priv;
2934 	unsigned long flags[BITS_TO_LONGS(NUM_IEEE80211_HW_FLAGS)];
2935 	unsigned int extra_tx_headroom;
2936 	unsigned int extra_beacon_tailroom;
2937 	int vif_data_size;
2938 	int sta_data_size;
2939 	int chanctx_data_size;
2940 	int txq_data_size;
2941 	u16 queues;
2942 	u16 max_listen_interval;
2943 	s8 max_signal;
2944 	u8 max_rates;
2945 	u8 max_report_rates;
2946 	u8 max_rate_tries;
2947 	u16 max_rx_aggregation_subframes;
2948 	u16 max_tx_aggregation_subframes;
2949 	u8 max_tx_fragments;
2950 	u8 offchannel_tx_hw_queue;
2951 	u8 radiotap_mcs_details;
2952 	u16 radiotap_vht_details;
2953 	struct {
2954 		int units_pos;
2955 		s16 accuracy;
2956 	} radiotap_timestamp;
2957 	netdev_features_t netdev_features;
2958 	u8 uapsd_queues;
2959 	u8 uapsd_max_sp_len;
2960 	u8 max_nan_de_entries;
2961 	u8 tx_sk_pacing_shift;
2962 	u8 weight_multiplier;
2963 	u32 max_mtu;
2964 	const s8 *tx_power_levels;
2965 	u8 max_txpwr_levels_idx;
2966 };
2967 
2968 static inline bool _ieee80211_hw_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2969 				       enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2970 {
2971 	return test_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2972 }
2973 #define ieee80211_hw_check(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_check(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2974 
2975 static inline void _ieee80211_hw_set(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
2976 				     enum ieee80211_hw_flags flg)
2977 {
2978 	return __set_bit(flg, hw->flags);
2979 }
2980 #define ieee80211_hw_set(hw, flg)	_ieee80211_hw_set(hw, IEEE80211_HW_##flg)
2981 
2982 /**
2983  * struct ieee80211_scan_request - hw scan request
2984  *
2985  * @ies: pointers different parts of IEs (in req.ie)
2986  * @req: cfg80211 request.
2987  */
2988 struct ieee80211_scan_request {
2989 	struct ieee80211_scan_ies ies;
2990 
2991 	/* Keep last */
2992 	struct cfg80211_scan_request req;
2993 };
2994 
2995 /**
2996  * struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params - TDLS channel switch parameters
2997  *
2998  * @sta: peer this TDLS channel-switch request/response came from
2999  * @chandef: channel referenced in a TDLS channel-switch request
3000  * @action_code: see &enum ieee80211_tdls_actioncode
3001  * @status: channel-switch response status
3002  * @timestamp: time at which the frame was received
3003  * @switch_time: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3004  * @switch_timeout: switch-timing parameter received in the frame
3005  * @tmpl_skb: TDLS switch-channel response template
3006  * @ch_sw_tm_ie: offset of the channel-switch timing IE inside @tmpl_skb
3007  */
3008 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params {
3009 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3010 	struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef;
3011 	u8 action_code;
3012 	u32 status;
3013 	u32 timestamp;
3014 	u16 switch_time;
3015 	u16 switch_timeout;
3016 	struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb;
3017 	u32 ch_sw_tm_ie;
3018 };
3019 
3020 /**
3021  * wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw - return a mac80211 driver hw struct from a wiphy
3022  *
3023  * @wiphy: the &struct wiphy which we want to query
3024  *
3025  * mac80211 drivers can use this to get to their respective
3026  * &struct ieee80211_hw. Drivers wishing to get to their own private
3027  * structure can then access it via hw->priv. Note that mac802111 drivers should
3028  * not use wiphy_priv() to try to get their private driver structure as this
3029  * is already used internally by mac80211.
3030  *
3031  * Return: The mac80211 driver hw struct of @wiphy.
3032  */
3033 struct ieee80211_hw *wiphy_to_ieee80211_hw(struct wiphy *wiphy);
3034 
3035 /**
3036  * SET_IEEE80211_DEV - set device for 802.11 hardware
3037  *
3038  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the device for
3039  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
3040  */
3041 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_DEV(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct device *dev)
3042 {
3043 	set_wiphy_dev(hw->wiphy, dev);
3044 }
3045 
3046 /**
3047  * SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR - set the permanent MAC address for 802.11 hardware
3048  *
3049  * @hw: the &struct ieee80211_hw to set the MAC address for
3050  * @addr: the address to set
3051  */
3052 static inline void SET_IEEE80211_PERM_ADDR(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, const u8 *addr)
3053 {
3054 	memcpy(hw->wiphy->perm_addr, addr, ETH_ALEN);
3055 }
3056 
3057 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3058 ieee80211_get_tx_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3059 		      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3060 {
3061 	if (WARN_ON_ONCE(c->control.rates[0].idx < 0))
3062 		return NULL;
3063 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[0].idx];
3064 }
3065 
3066 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3067 ieee80211_get_rts_cts_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3068 			   const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c)
3069 {
3070 	if (c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx < 0)
3071 		return NULL;
3072 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rts_cts_rate_idx];
3073 }
3074 
3075 static inline struct ieee80211_rate *
3076 ieee80211_get_alt_retry_rate(const struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
3077 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *c, int idx)
3078 {
3079 	if (c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx < 0)
3080 		return NULL;
3081 	return &hw->wiphy->bands[c->band]->bitrates[c->control.rates[idx + 1].idx];
3082 }
3083 
3084 /**
3085  * ieee80211_free_txskb - free TX skb
3086  * @hw: the hardware
3087  * @skb: the skb
3088  *
3089  * Free a transmit skb. Use this function when some failure
3090  * to transmit happened and thus status cannot be reported.
3091  */
3092 void ieee80211_free_txskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
3093 
3094 /**
3095  * DOC: Hardware crypto acceleration
3096  *
3097  * mac80211 is capable of taking advantage of many hardware
3098  * acceleration designs for encryption and decryption operations.
3099  *
3100  * The set_key() callback in the &struct ieee80211_ops for a given
3101  * device is called to enable hardware acceleration of encryption and
3102  * decryption. The callback takes a @sta parameter that will be NULL
3103  * for default keys or keys used for transmission only, or point to
3104  * the station information for the peer for individual keys.
3105  * Multiple transmission keys with the same key index may be used when
3106  * VLANs are configured for an access point.
3107  *
3108  * When transmitting, the TX control data will use the @hw_key_idx
3109  * selected by the driver by modifying the &struct ieee80211_key_conf
3110  * pointed to by the @key parameter to the set_key() function.
3111  *
3112  * The set_key() call for the %SET_KEY command should return 0 if
3113  * the key is now in use, -%EOPNOTSUPP or -%ENOSPC if it couldn't be
3114  * added; if you return 0 then hw_key_idx must be assigned to the
3115  * hardware key index. You are free to use the full u8 range.
3116  *
3117  * Note that in the case that the @IEEE80211_HW_SW_CRYPTO_CONTROL flag is
3118  * set, mac80211 will not automatically fall back to software crypto if
3119  * enabling hardware crypto failed. The set_key() call may also return the
3120  * value 1 to permit this specific key/algorithm to be done in software.
3121  *
3122  * When the cmd is %DISABLE_KEY then it must succeed.
3123  *
3124  * Note that it is permissible to not decrypt a frame even if a key
3125  * for it has been uploaded to hardware. The stack will not make any
3126  * decision based on whether a key has been uploaded or not but rather
3127  * based on the receive flags.
3128  *
3129  * The &struct ieee80211_key_conf structure pointed to by the @key
3130  * parameter is guaranteed to be valid until another call to set_key()
3131  * removes it, but it can only be used as a cookie to differentiate
3132  * keys.
3133  *
3134  * In TKIP some HW need to be provided a phase 1 key, for RX decryption
3135  * acceleration (i.e. iwlwifi). Those drivers should provide update_tkip_key
3136  * handler.
3137  * The update_tkip_key() call updates the driver with the new phase 1 key.
3138  * This happens every time the iv16 wraps around (every 65536 packets). The
3139  * set_key() call will happen only once for each key (unless the AP did
3140  * rekeying); it will not include a valid phase 1 key. The valid phase 1 key is
3141  * provided by update_tkip_key only. The trigger that makes mac80211 call this
3142  * handler is software decryption with wrap around of iv16.
3143  *
3144  * The set_default_unicast_key() call updates the default WEP key index
3145  * configured to the hardware for WEP encryption type. This is required
3146  * for devices that support offload of data packets (e.g. ARP responses).
3147  *
3148  * Mac80211 drivers should set the @NL80211_EXT_FEATURE_CAN_REPLACE_PTK0 flag
3149  * when they are able to replace in-use PTK keys according to the following
3150  * requirements:
3151  * 1) They do not hand over frames decrypted with the old key to mac80211
3152       once the call to set_key() with command %DISABLE_KEY has been completed,
3153    2) either drop or continue to use the old key for any outgoing frames queued
3154       at the time of the key deletion (including re-transmits),
3155    3) never send out a frame queued prior to the set_key() %SET_KEY command
3156       encrypted with the new key when also needing
3157       @IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_GENERATE_IV and
3158    4) never send out a frame unencrypted when it should be encrypted.
3159    Mac80211 will not queue any new frames for a deleted key to the driver.
3160  */
3161 
3162 /**
3163  * DOC: Powersave support
3164  *
3165  * mac80211 has support for various powersave implementations.
3166  *
3167  * First, it can support hardware that handles all powersaving by itself;
3168  * such hardware should simply set the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS hardware
3169  * flag. In that case, it will be told about the desired powersave mode
3170  * with the %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag depending on the association status.
3171  * The hardware must take care of sending nullfunc frames when necessary,
3172  * i.e. when entering and leaving powersave mode. The hardware is required
3173  * to look at the AID in beacons and signal to the AP that it woke up when
3174  * it finds traffic directed to it.
3175  *
3176  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS flag enabled means that the powersave mode defined in
3177  * IEEE 802.11-2007 section 11.2 is enabled. This is not to be confused
3178  * with hardware wakeup and sleep states. Driver is responsible for waking
3179  * up the hardware before issuing commands to the hardware and putting it
3180  * back to sleep at appropriate times.
3181  *
3182  * When PS is enabled, hardware needs to wakeup for beacons and receive the
3183  * buffered multicast/broadcast frames after the beacon. Also it must be
3184  * possible to send frames and receive the acknowledment frame.
3185  *
3186  * Other hardware designs cannot send nullfunc frames by themselves and also
3187  * need software support for parsing the TIM bitmap. This is also supported
3188  * by mac80211 by combining the %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS and
3189  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK flags. The hardware is of course still
3190  * required to pass up beacons. The hardware is still required to handle
3191  * waking up for multicast traffic; if it cannot the driver must handle that
3192  * as best as it can; mac80211 is too slow to do that.
3193  *
3194  * Dynamic powersave is an extension to normal powersave in which the
3195  * hardware stays awake for a user-specified period of time after sending a
3196  * frame so that reply frames need not be buffered and therefore delayed to
3197  * the next wakeup. It's a compromise of getting good enough latency when
3198  * there's data traffic and still saving significantly power in idle
3199  * periods.
3200  *
3201  * Dynamic powersave is simply supported by mac80211 enabling and disabling
3202  * PS based on traffic. Driver needs to only set %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_PS
3203  * flag and mac80211 will handle everything automatically. Additionally,
3204  * hardware having support for the dynamic PS feature may set the
3205  * %IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_DYNAMIC_PS flag to indicate that it can support
3206  * dynamic PS mode itself. The driver needs to look at the
3207  * @dynamic_ps_timeout hardware configuration value and use it that value
3208  * whenever %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. In this case mac80211 will disable
3209  * dynamic PS feature in stack and will just keep %IEEE80211_CONF_PS
3210  * enabled whenever user has enabled powersave.
3211  *
3212  * Driver informs U-APSD client support by enabling
3213  * %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_UAPSD flag. The mode is configured through the
3214  * uapsd parameter in conf_tx() operation. Hardware needs to send the QoS
3215  * Nullfunc frames and stay awake until the service period has ended. To
3216  * utilize U-APSD, dynamic powersave is disabled for voip AC and all frames
3217  * from that AC are transmitted with powersave enabled.
3218  *
3219  * Note: U-APSD client mode is not yet supported with
3220  * %IEEE80211_HW_PS_NULLFUNC_STACK.
3221  */
3222 
3223 /**
3224  * DOC: Beacon filter support
3225  *
3226  * Some hardware have beacon filter support to reduce host cpu wakeups
3227  * which will reduce system power consumption. It usually works so that
3228  * the firmware creates a checksum of the beacon but omits all constantly
3229  * changing elements (TSF, TIM etc). Whenever the checksum changes the
3230  * beacon is forwarded to the host, otherwise it will be just dropped. That
3231  * way the host will only receive beacons where some relevant information
3232  * (for example ERP protection or WMM settings) have changed.
3233  *
3234  * Beacon filter support is advertised with the %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER
3235  * interface capability. The driver needs to enable beacon filter support
3236  * whenever power save is enabled, that is %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set. When
3237  * power save is enabled, the stack will not check for beacon loss and the
3238  * driver needs to notify about loss of beacons with ieee80211_beacon_loss().
3239  *
3240  * The time (or number of beacons missed) until the firmware notifies the
3241  * driver of a beacon loss event (which in turn causes the driver to call
3242  * ieee80211_beacon_loss()) should be configurable and will be controlled
3243  * by mac80211 and the roaming algorithm in the future.
3244  *
3245  * Since there may be constantly changing information elements that nothing
3246  * in the software stack cares about, we will, in the future, have mac80211
3247  * tell the driver which information elements are interesting in the sense
3248  * that we want to see changes in them. This will include
3249  *
3250  *  - a list of information element IDs
3251  *  - a list of OUIs for the vendor information element
3252  *
3253  * Ideally, the hardware would filter out any beacons without changes in the
3254  * requested elements, but if it cannot support that it may, at the expense
3255  * of some efficiency, filter out only a subset. For example, if the device
3256  * doesn't support checking for OUIs it should pass up all changes in all
3257  * vendor information elements.
3258  *
3259  * Note that change, for the sake of simplification, also includes information
3260  * elements appearing or disappearing from the beacon.
3261  *
3262  * Some hardware supports an "ignore list" instead. Just make sure nothing
3263  * that was requested is on the ignore list, and include commonly changing
3264  * information element IDs in the ignore list, for example 11 (BSS load) and
3265  * the various vendor-assigned IEs with unknown contents (128, 129, 133-136,
3266  * 149, 150, 155, 156, 173, 176, 178, 179, 219); for forward compatibility
3267  * it could also include some currently unused IDs.
3268  *
3269  *
3270  * In addition to these capabilities, hardware should support notifying the
3271  * host of changes in the beacon RSSI. This is relevant to implement roaming
3272  * when no traffic is flowing (when traffic is flowing we see the RSSI of
3273  * the received data packets). This can consist of notifying the host when
3274  * the RSSI changes significantly or when it drops below or rises above
3275  * configurable thresholds. In the future these thresholds will also be
3276  * configured by mac80211 (which gets them from userspace) to implement
3277  * them as the roaming algorithm requires.
3278  *
3279  * If the hardware cannot implement this, the driver should ask it to
3280  * periodically pass beacon frames to the host so that software can do the
3281  * signal strength threshold checking.
3282  */
3283 
3284 /**
3285  * DOC: Spatial multiplexing power save
3286  *
3287  * SMPS (Spatial multiplexing power save) is a mechanism to conserve
3288  * power in an 802.11n implementation. For details on the mechanism
3289  * and rationale, please refer to 802.11 (as amended by 802.11n-2009)
3290  * "11.2.3 SM power save".
3291  *
3292  * The mac80211 implementation is capable of sending action frames
3293  * to update the AP about the station's SMPS mode, and will instruct
3294  * the driver to enter the specific mode. It will also announce the
3295  * requested SMPS mode during the association handshake. Hardware
3296  * support for this feature is required, and can be indicated by
3297  * hardware flags.
3298  *
3299  * The default mode will be "automatic", which nl80211/cfg80211
3300  * defines to be dynamic SMPS in (regular) powersave, and SMPS
3301  * turned off otherwise.
3302  *
3303  * To support this feature, the driver must set the appropriate
3304  * hardware support flags, and handle the SMPS flag to the config()
3305  * operation. It will then with this mechanism be instructed to
3306  * enter the requested SMPS mode while associated to an HT AP.
3307  */
3308 
3309 /**
3310  * DOC: Frame filtering
3311  *
3312  * mac80211 requires to see many management frames for proper
3313  * operation, and users may want to see many more frames when
3314  * in monitor mode. However, for best CPU usage and power consumption,
3315  * having as few frames as possible percolate through the stack is
3316  * desirable. Hence, the hardware should filter as much as possible.
3317  *
3318  * To achieve this, mac80211 uses filter flags (see below) to tell
3319  * the driver's configure_filter() function which frames should be
3320  * passed to mac80211 and which should be filtered out.
3321  *
3322  * Before configure_filter() is invoked, the prepare_multicast()
3323  * callback is invoked with the parameters @mc_count and @mc_list
3324  * for the combined multicast address list of all virtual interfaces.
3325  * It's use is optional, and it returns a u64 that is passed to
3326  * configure_filter(). Additionally, configure_filter() has the
3327  * arguments @changed_flags telling which flags were changed and
3328  * @total_flags with the new flag states.
3329  *
3330  * If your device has no multicast address filters your driver will
3331  * need to check both the %FIF_ALLMULTI flag and the @mc_count
3332  * parameter to see whether multicast frames should be accepted
3333  * or dropped.
3334  *
3335  * All unsupported flags in @total_flags must be cleared.
3336  * Hardware does not support a flag if it is incapable of _passing_
3337  * the frame to the stack. Otherwise the driver must ignore
3338  * the flag, but not clear it.
3339  * You must _only_ clear the flag (announce no support for the
3340  * flag to mac80211) if you are not able to pass the packet type
3341  * to the stack (so the hardware always filters it).
3342  * So for example, you should clear @FIF_CONTROL, if your hardware
3343  * always filters control frames. If your hardware always passes
3344  * control frames to the kernel and is incapable of filtering them,
3345  * you do _not_ clear the @FIF_CONTROL flag.
3346  * This rule applies to all other FIF flags as well.
3347  */
3348 
3349 /**
3350  * DOC: AP support for powersaving clients
3351  *
3352  * In order to implement AP and P2P GO modes, mac80211 has support for
3353  * client powersaving, both "legacy" PS (PS-Poll/null data) and uAPSD.
3354  * There currently is no support for sAPSD.
3355  *
3356  * There is one assumption that mac80211 makes, namely that a client
3357  * will not poll with PS-Poll and trigger with uAPSD at the same time.
3358  * Both are supported, and both can be used by the same client, but
3359  * they can't be used concurrently by the same client. This simplifies
3360  * the driver code.
3361  *
3362  * The first thing to keep in mind is that there is a flag for complete
3363  * driver implementation: %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS. If this flag is set,
3364  * mac80211 expects the driver to handle most of the state machine for
3365  * powersaving clients and will ignore the PM bit in incoming frames.
3366  * Drivers then use ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() to inform mac80211 of
3367  * stations' powersave transitions. In this mode, mac80211 also doesn't
3368  * handle PS-Poll/uAPSD.
3369  *
3370  * In the mode without %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS, mac80211 will check the
3371  * PM bit in incoming frames for client powersave transitions. When a
3372  * station goes to sleep, we will stop transmitting to it. There is,
3373  * however, a race condition: a station might go to sleep while there is
3374  * data buffered on hardware queues. If the device has support for this
3375  * it will reject frames, and the driver should give the frames back to
3376  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_STAT_TX_FILTERED flag set which will
3377  * cause mac80211 to retry the frame when the station wakes up. The
3378  * driver is also notified of powersave transitions by calling its
3379  * @sta_notify callback.
3380  *
3381  * When the station is asleep, it has three choices: it can wake up,
3382  * it can PS-Poll, or it can possibly start a uAPSD service period.
3383  * Waking up is implemented by simply transmitting all buffered (and
3384  * filtered) frames to the station. This is the easiest case. When
3385  * the station sends a PS-Poll or a uAPSD trigger frame, mac80211
3386  * will inform the driver of this with the @allow_buffered_frames
3387  * callback; this callback is optional. mac80211 will then transmit
3388  * the frames as usual and set the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER
3389  * on each frame. The last frame in the service period (or the only
3390  * response to a PS-Poll) also has %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set to
3391  * indicate that it ends the service period; as this frame must have
3392  * TX status report it also sets %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_REQ_TX_STATUS.
3393  * When TX status is reported for this frame, the service period is
3394  * marked has having ended and a new one can be started by the peer.
3395  *
3396  * Additionally, non-bufferable MMPDUs can also be transmitted by
3397  * mac80211 with the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER set in them.
3398  *
3399  * Another race condition can happen on some devices like iwlwifi
3400  * when there are frames queued for the station and it wakes up
3401  * or polls; the frames that are already queued could end up being
3402  * transmitted first instead, causing reordering and/or wrong
3403  * processing of the EOSP. The cause is that allowing frames to be
3404  * transmitted to a certain station is out-of-band communication to
3405  * the device. To allow this problem to be solved, the driver can
3406  * call ieee80211_sta_block_awake() if frames are buffered when it
3407  * is notified that the station went to sleep. When all these frames
3408  * have been filtered (see above), it must call the function again
3409  * to indicate that the station is no longer blocked.
3410  *
3411  * If the driver buffers frames in the driver for aggregation in any
3412  * way, it must use the ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() call when it is
3413  * notified of the station going to sleep to inform mac80211 of any
3414  * TIDs that have frames buffered. Note that when a station wakes up
3415  * this information is reset (hence the requirement to call it when
3416  * informed of the station going to sleep). Then, when a service
3417  * period starts for any reason, @release_buffered_frames is called
3418  * with the number of frames to be released and which TIDs they are
3419  * to come from. In this case, the driver is responsible for setting
3420  * the EOSP (for uAPSD) and MORE_DATA bits in the released frames.
3421  * To help the @more_data parameter is passed to tell the driver if
3422  * there is more data on other TIDs -- the TIDs to release frames
3423  * from are ignored since mac80211 doesn't know how many frames the
3424  * buffers for those TIDs contain.
3425  *
3426  * If the driver also implement GO mode, where absence periods may
3427  * shorten service periods (or abort PS-Poll responses), it must
3428  * filter those response frames except in the case of frames that
3429  * are buffered in the driver -- those must remain buffered to avoid
3430  * reordering. Because it is possible that no frames are released
3431  * in this case, the driver must call ieee80211_sta_eosp()
3432  * to indicate to mac80211 that the service period ended anyway.
3433  *
3434  * Finally, if frames from multiple TIDs are released from mac80211
3435  * but the driver might reorder them, it must clear & set the flags
3436  * appropriately (only the last frame may have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP)
3437  * and also take care of the EOSP and MORE_DATA bits in the frame.
3438  * The driver may also use ieee80211_sta_eosp() in this case.
3439  *
3440  * Note that if the driver ever buffers frames other than QoS-data
3441  * frames, it must take care to never send a non-QoS-data frame as
3442  * the last frame in a service period, adding a QoS-nulldata frame
3443  * after a non-QoS-data frame if needed.
3444  */
3445 
3446 /**
3447  * DOC: HW queue control
3448  *
3449  * Before HW queue control was introduced, mac80211 only had a single static
3450  * assignment of per-interface AC software queues to hardware queues. This
3451  * was problematic for a few reasons:
3452  * 1) off-channel transmissions might get stuck behind other frames
3453  * 2) multiple virtual interfaces couldn't be handled correctly
3454  * 3) after-DTIM frames could get stuck behind other frames
3455  *
3456  * To solve this, hardware typically uses multiple different queues for all
3457  * the different usages, and this needs to be propagated into mac80211 so it
3458  * won't have the same problem with the software queues.
3459  *
3460  * Therefore, mac80211 now offers the %IEEE80211_HW_QUEUE_CONTROL capability
3461  * flag that tells it that the driver implements its own queue control. To do
3462  * so, the driver will set up the various queues in each &struct ieee80211_vif
3463  * and the offchannel queue in &struct ieee80211_hw. In response, mac80211 will
3464  * use those queue IDs in the hw_queue field of &struct ieee80211_tx_info and
3465  * if necessary will queue the frame on the right software queue that mirrors
3466  * the hardware queue.
3467  * Additionally, the driver has to then use these HW queue IDs for the queue
3468  * management functions (ieee80211_stop_queue() et al.)
3469  *
3470  * The driver is free to set up the queue mappings as needed; multiple virtual
3471  * interfaces may map to the same hardware queues if needed. The setup has to
3472  * happen during add_interface or change_interface callbacks. For example, a
3473  * driver supporting station+station and station+AP modes might decide to have
3474  * 10 hardware queues to handle different scenarios:
3475  *
3476  * 4 AC HW queues for 1st vif: 0, 1, 2, 3
3477  * 4 AC HW queues for 2nd vif: 4, 5, 6, 7
3478  * after-DTIM queue for AP:   8
3479  * off-channel queue:         9
3480  *
3481  * It would then set up the hardware like this:
3482  *   hw.offchannel_tx_hw_queue = 9
3483  *
3484  * and the first virtual interface that is added as follows:
3485  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VO] = 0
3486  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_VI] = 1
3487  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BE] = 2
3488  *   vif.hw_queue[IEEE80211_AC_BK] = 3
3489  *   vif.cab_queue = 8 // if AP mode, otherwise %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3490  * and the second virtual interface with 4-7.
3491  *
3492  * If queue 6 gets full, for example, mac80211 would only stop the second
3493  * virtual interface's BE queue since virtual interface queues are per AC.
3494  *
3495  * Note that the vif.cab_queue value should be set to %IEEE80211_INVAL_HW_QUEUE
3496  * whenever the queue is not used (i.e. the interface is not in AP mode) if the
3497  * queue could potentially be shared since mac80211 will look at cab_queue when
3498  * a queue is stopped/woken even if the interface is not in AP mode.
3499  */
3500 
3501 /**
3502  * enum ieee80211_filter_flags - hardware filter flags
3503  *
3504  * These flags determine what the filter in hardware should be
3505  * programmed to let through and what should not be passed to the
3506  * stack. It is always safe to pass more frames than requested,
3507  * but this has negative impact on power consumption.
3508  *
3509  * @FIF_ALLMULTI: pass all multicast frames, this is used if requested
3510  *	by the user or if the hardware is not capable of filtering by
3511  *	multicast address.
3512  *
3513  * @FIF_FCSFAIL: pass frames with failed FCS (but you need to set the
3514  *	%RX_FLAG_FAILED_FCS_CRC for them)
3515  *
3516  * @FIF_PLCPFAIL: pass frames with failed PLCP CRC (but you need to set
3517  *	the %RX_FLAG_FAILED_PLCP_CRC for them
3518  *
3519  * @FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC: This flag is set during scanning to indicate
3520  *	to the hardware that it should not filter beacons or probe responses
3521  *	by BSSID. Filtering them can greatly reduce the amount of processing
3522  *	mac80211 needs to do and the amount of CPU wakeups, so you should
3523  *	honour this flag if possible.
3524  *
3525  * @FIF_CONTROL: pass control frames (except for PS Poll) addressed to this
3526  *	station
3527  *
3528  * @FIF_OTHER_BSS: pass frames destined to other BSSes
3529  *
3530  * @FIF_PSPOLL: pass PS Poll frames
3531  *
3532  * @FIF_PROBE_REQ: pass probe request frames
3533  *
3534  * @FIF_MCAST_ACTION: pass multicast Action frames
3535  */
3536 enum ieee80211_filter_flags {
3537 	FIF_ALLMULTI		= 1<<1,
3538 	FIF_FCSFAIL		= 1<<2,
3539 	FIF_PLCPFAIL		= 1<<3,
3540 	FIF_BCN_PRBRESP_PROMISC	= 1<<4,
3541 	FIF_CONTROL		= 1<<5,
3542 	FIF_OTHER_BSS		= 1<<6,
3543 	FIF_PSPOLL		= 1<<7,
3544 	FIF_PROBE_REQ		= 1<<8,
3545 	FIF_MCAST_ACTION	= 1<<9,
3546 };
3547 
3548 /**
3549  * enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action - A-MPDU actions
3550  *
3551  * These flags are used with the ampdu_action() callback in
3552  * &struct ieee80211_ops to indicate which action is needed.
3553  *
3554  * Note that drivers MUST be able to deal with a TX aggregation
3555  * session being stopped even before they OK'ed starting it by
3556  * calling ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe, because the peer
3557  * might receive the addBA frame and send a delBA right away!
3558  *
3559  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START: start RX aggregation
3560  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP: stop RX aggregation
3561  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START: start TX aggregation, the driver must either
3562  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() or
3563  *	call ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() with status
3564  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA to delay addba after
3565  *	ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe is called, or just return the special
3566  *	status %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE.
3567  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL: TX aggregation has become operational
3568  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT: stop TX aggregation but continue transmitting
3569  *	queued packets, now unaggregated. After all packets are transmitted the
3570  *	driver has to call ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe().
3571  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH: stop TX aggregation and flush all packets,
3572  *	called when the station is removed. There's no need or reason to call
3573  *	ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() in this case as mac80211 assumes the
3574  *	session is gone and removes the station.
3575  * @IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT: called when TX aggregation is stopped
3576  *	but the driver hasn't called ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe() yet and
3577  *	now the connection is dropped and the station will be removed. Drivers
3578  *	should clean up and drop remaining packets when this is called.
3579  */
3580 enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action {
3581 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START,
3582 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_STOP,
3583 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START,
3584 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_CONT,
3585 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH,
3586 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_STOP_FLUSH_CONT,
3587 	IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL,
3588 };
3589 
3590 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE 1
3591 #define IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_DELAY_ADDBA 2
3592 
3593 /**
3594  * struct ieee80211_ampdu_params - AMPDU action parameters
3595  *
3596  * @action: the ampdu action, value from %ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
3597  * @sta: peer of this AMPDU session
3598  * @tid: tid of the BA session
3599  * @ssn: start sequence number of the session. TX/RX_STOP can pass 0. When
3600  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START the driver passes back the
3601  *	actual ssn value used to start the session and writes the value here.
3602  * @buf_size: reorder buffer size  (number of subframes). Valid only when the
3603  *	action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START or
3604  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3605  * @amsdu: indicates the peer's ability to receive A-MSDU within A-MPDU.
3606  *	valid when the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL
3607  * @timeout: BA session timeout. Valid only when the action is set to
3608  *	%IEEE80211_AMPDU_RX_START
3609  */
3610 struct ieee80211_ampdu_params {
3611 	enum ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action action;
3612 	struct ieee80211_sta *sta;
3613 	u16 tid;
3614 	u16 ssn;
3615 	u16 buf_size;
3616 	bool amsdu;
3617 	u16 timeout;
3618 };
3619 
3620 /**
3621  * enum ieee80211_frame_release_type - frame release reason
3622  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL: frame released for PS-Poll
3623  * @IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD: frame(s) released due to
3624  *	frame received on trigger-enabled AC
3625  */
3626 enum ieee80211_frame_release_type {
3627 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_PSPOLL,
3628 	IEEE80211_FRAME_RELEASE_UAPSD,
3629 };
3630 
3631 /**
3632  * enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed - flags to indicate what changed
3633  *
3634  * @IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED: The bandwidth that can be used to transmit
3635  *	to this station changed. The actual bandwidth is in the station
3636  *	information -- for HT20/40 the IEEE80211_HT_CAP_SUP_WIDTH_20_40
3637  *	flag changes, for HT and VHT the bandwidth field changes.
3638  * @IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED: The SMPS state of the station changed.
3639  * @IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED: The supported rate set of this peer
3640  *	changed (in IBSS mode) due to discovering more information about
3641  *	the peer.
3642  * @IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED: N_SS (number of spatial streams) was changed
3643  *	by the peer
3644  */
3645 enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed {
3646 	IEEE80211_RC_BW_CHANGED		= BIT(0),
3647 	IEEE80211_RC_SMPS_CHANGED	= BIT(1),
3648 	IEEE80211_RC_SUPP_RATES_CHANGED	= BIT(2),
3649 	IEEE80211_RC_NSS_CHANGED	= BIT(3),
3650 };
3651 
3652 /**
3653  * enum ieee80211_roc_type - remain on channel type
3654  *
3655  * With the support for multi channel contexts and multi channel operations,
3656  * remain on channel operations might be limited/deferred/aborted by other
3657  * flows/operations which have higher priority (and vice versa).
3658  * Specifying the ROC type can be used by devices to prioritize the ROC
3659  * operations compared to other operations/flows.
3660  *
3661  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL: There are no special requirements for this ROC.
3662  * @IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX: The remain on channel request is required
3663  *	for sending management frames offchannel.
3664  */
3665 enum ieee80211_roc_type {
3666 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_NORMAL = 0,
3667 	IEEE80211_ROC_TYPE_MGMT_TX,
3668 };
3669 
3670 /**
3671  * enum ieee80211_reconfig_type - reconfig type
3672  *
3673  * This enum is used by the reconfig_complete() callback to indicate what
3674  * reconfiguration type was completed.
3675  *
3676  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART: hw restart type
3677  *	(also due to resume() callback returning 1)
3678  * @IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND: suspend type (regardless
3679  *	of wowlan configuration)
3680  */
3681 enum ieee80211_reconfig_type {
3682 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_RESTART,
3683 	IEEE80211_RECONFIG_TYPE_SUSPEND,
3684 };
3685 
3686 /**
3687  * struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info - prepare TX information
3688  * @duration: if non-zero, hint about the required duration,
3689  *	only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3690  * @subtype: frame subtype (auth, (re)assoc, deauth, disassoc)
3691  * @success: whether the frame exchange was successful, only
3692  *	used with the mgd_complete_tx() method, and then only
3693  *	valid for auth and (re)assoc.
3694  * @link_id: the link id on which the frame will be TX'ed.
3695  *	Only used with the mgd_prepare_tx() method.
3696  */
3697 struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info {
3698 	u16 duration;
3699 	u16 subtype;
3700 	u8 success:1;
3701 	int link_id;
3702 };
3703 
3704 /**
3705  * struct ieee80211_ops - callbacks from mac80211 to the driver
3706  *
3707  * This structure contains various callbacks that the driver may
3708  * handle or, in some cases, must handle, for example to configure
3709  * the hardware to a new channel or to transmit a frame.
3710  *
3711  * @tx: Handler that 802.11 module calls for each transmitted frame.
3712  *	skb contains the buffer starting from the IEEE 802.11 header.
3713  *	The low-level driver should send the frame out based on
3714  *	configuration in the TX control data. This handler should,
3715  *	preferably, never fail and stop queues appropriately.
3716  *	Must be atomic.
3717  *
3718  * @start: Called before the first netdevice attached to the hardware
3719  *	is enabled. This should turn on the hardware and must turn on
3720  *	frame reception (for possibly enabled monitor interfaces.)
3721  *	Returns negative error codes, these may be seen in userspace,
3722  *	or zero.
3723  *	When the device is started it should not have a MAC address
3724  *	to avoid acknowledging frames before a non-monitor device
3725  *	is added.
3726  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3727  *
3728  * @stop: Called after last netdevice attached to the hardware
3729  *	is disabled. This should turn off the hardware (at least
3730  *	it must turn off frame reception.)
3731  *	May be called right after add_interface if that rejects
3732  *	an interface. If you added any work onto the mac80211 workqueue
3733  *	you should ensure to cancel it on this callback.
3734  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3735  *
3736  * @suspend: Suspend the device; mac80211 itself will quiesce before and
3737  *	stop transmitting and doing any other configuration, and then
3738  *	ask the device to suspend. This is only invoked when WoWLAN is
3739  *	configured, otherwise the device is deconfigured completely and
3740  *	reconfigured at resume time.
3741  *	The driver may also impose special conditions under which it
3742  *	wants to use the "normal" suspend (deconfigure), say if it only
3743  *	supports WoWLAN when the device is associated. In this case, it
3744  *	must return 1 from this function.
3745  *
3746  * @resume: If WoWLAN was configured, this indicates that mac80211 is
3747  *	now resuming its operation, after this the device must be fully
3748  *	functional again. If this returns an error, the only way out is
3749  *	to also unregister the device. If it returns 1, then mac80211
3750  *	will also go through the regular complete restart on resume.
3751  *
3752  * @set_wakeup: Enable or disable wakeup when WoWLAN configuration is
3753  *	modified. The reason is that device_set_wakeup_enable() is
3754  *	supposed to be called when the configuration changes, not only
3755  *	in suspend().
3756  *
3757  * @add_interface: Called when a netdevice attached to the hardware is
3758  *	enabled. Because it is not called for monitor mode devices, @start
3759  *	and @stop must be implemented.
3760  *	The driver should perform any initialization it needs before
3761  *	the device can be enabled. The initial configuration for the
3762  *	interface is given in the conf parameter.
3763  *	The callback may refuse to add an interface by returning a
3764  *	negative error code (which will be seen in userspace.)
3765  *	Must be implemented and can sleep.
3766  *
3767  * @change_interface: Called when a netdevice changes type. This callback
3768  *	is optional, but only if it is supported can interface types be
3769  *	switched while the interface is UP. The callback may sleep.
3770  *	Note that while an interface is being switched, it will not be
3771  *	found by the interface iteration callbacks.
3772  *
3773  * @remove_interface: Notifies a driver that an interface is going down.
3774  *	The @stop callback is called after this if it is the last interface
3775  *	and no monitor interfaces are present.
3776  *	When all interfaces are removed, the MAC address in the hardware
3777  *	must be cleared so the device no longer acknowledges packets,
3778  *	the mac_addr member of the conf structure is, however, set to the
3779  *	MAC address of the device going away.
3780  *	Hence, this callback must be implemented. It can sleep.
3781  *
3782  * @config: Handler for configuration requests. IEEE 802.11 code calls this
3783  *	function to change hardware configuration, e.g., channel.
3784  *	This function should never fail but returns a negative error code
3785  *	if it does. The callback can sleep.
3786  *
3787  * @bss_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to BSS
3788  *	parameters that may vary during BSS's lifespan, and may affect low
3789  *	level driver (e.g. assoc/disassoc status, erp parameters).
3790  *	This function should not be used if no BSS has been set, unless
3791  *	for association indication. The @changed parameter indicates which
3792  *	of the bss parameters has changed when a call is made. The callback
3793  *	can sleep.
3794  *	Note: this callback is called if @vif_cfg_changed or @link_info_changed
3795  *	are not implemented.
3796  *
3797  * @vif_cfg_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to interface
3798  *	(MLD) parameters from &struct ieee80211_vif_cfg that vary during the
3799  *	lifetime of the interface (e.g. assoc status, IP addresses, etc.)
3800  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed.
3801  *	The callback can sleep.
3802  *
3803  * @link_info_changed: Handler for configuration requests related to link
3804  *	parameters from &struct ieee80211_bss_conf that are related to an
3805  *	individual link. e.g. legacy/HT/VHT/... rate information.
3806  *	The @changed parameter indicates which value changed, and the @link_id
3807  *	parameter indicates the link ID. Note that the @link_id will be 0 for
3808  *	non-MLO connections.
3809  *	The callback can sleep.
3810  *
3811  * @prepare_multicast: Prepare for multicast filter configuration.
3812  *	This callback is optional, and its return value is passed
3813  *	to configure_filter(). This callback must be atomic.
3814  *
3815  * @configure_filter: Configure the device's RX filter.
3816  *	See the section "Frame filtering" for more information.
3817  *	This callback must be implemented and can sleep.
3818  *
3819  * @config_iface_filter: Configure the interface's RX filter.
3820  *	This callback is optional and is used to configure which frames
3821  *	should be passed to mac80211. The filter_flags is the combination
3822  *	of FIF_* flags. The changed_flags is a bit mask that indicates
3823  *	which flags are changed.
3824  *	This callback can sleep.
3825  *
3826  * @set_tim: Set TIM bit. mac80211 calls this function when a TIM bit
3827  * 	must be set or cleared for a given STA. Must be atomic.
3828  *
3829  * @set_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3830  *	This callback is only called between add_interface and
3831  *	remove_interface calls, i.e. while the given virtual interface
3832  *	is enabled.
3833  *	Returns a negative error code if the key can't be added.
3834  *	The callback can sleep.
3835  *
3836  * @update_tkip_key: See the section "Hardware crypto acceleration"
3837  * 	This callback will be called in the context of Rx. Called for drivers
3838  * 	which set IEEE80211_KEY_FLAG_TKIP_REQ_RX_P1_KEY.
3839  *	The callback must be atomic.
3840  *
3841  * @set_rekey_data: If the device supports GTK rekeying, for example while the
3842  *	host is suspended, it can assign this callback to retrieve the data
3843  *	necessary to do GTK rekeying, this is the KEK, KCK and replay counter.
3844  *	After rekeying was done it should (for example during resume) notify
3845  *	userspace of the new replay counter using ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify().
3846  *
3847  * @set_default_unicast_key: Set the default (unicast) key index, useful for
3848  *	WEP when the device sends data packets autonomously, e.g. for ARP
3849  *	offloading. The index can be 0-3, or -1 for unsetting it.
3850  *
3851  * @hw_scan: Ask the hardware to service the scan request, no need to start
3852  *	the scan state machine in stack. The scan must honour the channel
3853  *	configuration done by the regulatory agent in the wiphy's
3854  *	registered bands. The hardware (or the driver) needs to make sure
3855  *	that power save is disabled.
3856  *	The @req ie/ie_len members are rewritten by mac80211 to contain the
3857  *	entire IEs after the SSID, so that drivers need not look at these
3858  *	at all but just send them after the SSID -- mac80211 includes the
3859  *	(extended) supported rates and HT information (where applicable).
3860  *	When the scan finishes, ieee80211_scan_completed() must be called;
3861  *	note that it also must be called when the scan cannot finish due to
3862  *	any error unless this callback returned a negative error code.
3863  *	This callback is also allowed to return the special return value 1,
3864  *	this indicates that hardware scan isn't desirable right now and a
3865  *	software scan should be done instead. A driver wishing to use this
3866  *	capability must ensure its (hardware) scan capabilities aren't
3867  *	advertised as more capable than mac80211's software scan is.
3868  *	The callback can sleep.
3869  *
3870  * @cancel_hw_scan: Ask the low-level tp cancel the active hw scan.
3871  *	The driver should ask the hardware to cancel the scan (if possible),
3872  *	but the scan will be completed only after the driver will call
3873  *	ieee80211_scan_completed().
3874  *	This callback is needed for wowlan, to prevent enqueueing a new
3875  *	scan_work after the low-level driver was already suspended.
3876  *	The callback can sleep.
3877  *
3878  * @sched_scan_start: Ask the hardware to start scanning repeatedly at
3879  *	specific intervals.  The driver must call the
3880  *	ieee80211_sched_scan_results() function whenever it finds results.
3881  *	This process will continue until sched_scan_stop is called.
3882  *
3883  * @sched_scan_stop: Tell the hardware to stop an ongoing scheduled scan.
3884  *	In this case, ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped() must not be called.
3885  *
3886  * @sw_scan_start: Notifier function that is called just before a software scan
3887  *	is started. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need this notification.
3888  *	The mac_addr parameter allows supporting NL80211_SCAN_FLAG_RANDOM_ADDR,
3889  *	the driver may set the NL80211_FEATURE_SCAN_RANDOM_MAC_ADDR flag if it
3890  *	can use this parameter. The callback can sleep.
3891  *
3892  * @sw_scan_complete: Notifier function that is called just after a
3893  *	software scan finished. Can be NULL, if the driver doesn't need
3894  *	this notification.
3895  *	The callback can sleep.
3896  *
3897  * @get_stats: Return low-level statistics.
3898  * 	Returns zero if statistics are available.
3899  *	The callback can sleep.
3900  *
3901  * @get_key_seq: If your device implements encryption in hardware and does
3902  *	IV/PN assignment then this callback should be provided to read the
3903  *	IV/PN for the given key from hardware.
3904  *	The callback must be atomic.
3905  *
3906  * @set_frag_threshold: Configuration of fragmentation threshold. Assign this
3907  *	if the device does fragmentation by itself. Note that to prevent the
3908  *	stack from doing fragmentation IEEE80211_HW_SUPPORTS_TX_FRAG
3909  *	should be set as well.
3910  *	The callback can sleep.
3911  *
3912  * @set_rts_threshold: Configuration of RTS threshold (if device needs it)
3913  *	The callback can sleep.
3914  *
3915  * @sta_add: Notifies low level driver about addition of an associated station,
3916  *	AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. This callback can sleep.
3917  *
3918  * @sta_remove: Notifies low level driver about removal of an associated
3919  *	station, AP, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. Note that after the callback
3920  *	returns it isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected;
3921  *	no RCU grace period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing
3922  *	the station. See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3923  *	This callback can sleep.
3924  *
3925  * @vif_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add a debugfs vif
3926  *	directory with its files. This callback should be within a
3927  *	CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
3928  *
3929  * @link_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3930  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 vif. This callback should be within
3931  *	a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This callback can sleep.
3932  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the default bss_conf
3933  *	with the vif's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3934  *
3935  * @sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3936  *	when a station is added to mac80211's station list. This callback
3937  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3938  *	callback can sleep.
3939  *
3940  * @link_sta_add_debugfs: Drivers can use this callback to add debugfs files
3941  *	when a link is added to a mac80211 station. This callback
3942  *	should be within a CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS conditional. This
3943  *	callback can sleep.
3944  *	For non-MLO the callback will be called once for the deflink with the
3945  *	station's directory rather than a separate subdirectory.
3946  *
3947  * @sta_notify: Notifies low level driver about power state transition of an
3948  *	associated station, AP,  IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc. For a VIF operating
3949  *	in AP mode, this callback will not be called when the flag
3950  *	%IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS is set. Must be atomic.
3951  *
3952  * @sta_set_txpwr: Configure the station tx power. This callback set the tx
3953  *	power for the station.
3954  *	This callback can sleep.
3955  *
3956  * @sta_state: Notifies low level driver about state transition of a
3957  *	station (which can be the AP, a client, IBSS/WDS/mesh peer etc.)
3958  *	This callback is mutually exclusive with @sta_add/@sta_remove.
3959  *	It must not fail for down transitions but may fail for transitions
3960  *	up the list of states. Also note that after the callback returns it
3961  *	isn't safe to use the pointer, not even RCU protected - no RCU grace
3962  *	period is guaranteed between returning here and freeing the station.
3963  *	See @sta_pre_rcu_remove if needed.
3964  *	The callback can sleep.
3965  *
3966  * @sta_pre_rcu_remove: Notify driver about station removal before RCU
3967  *	synchronisation. This is useful if a driver needs to have station
3968  *	pointers protected using RCU, it can then use this call to clear
3969  *	the pointers instead of waiting for an RCU grace period to elapse
3970  *	in @sta_state.
3971  *	The callback can sleep.
3972  *
3973  * @sta_rc_update: Notifies the driver of changes to the bitrates that can be
3974  *	used to transmit to the station. The changes are advertised with bits
3975  *	from &enum ieee80211_rate_control_changed and the values are reflected
3976  *	in the station data. This callback should only be used when the driver
3977  *	uses hardware rate control (%IEEE80211_HW_HAS_RATE_CONTROL) since
3978  *	otherwise the rate control algorithm is notified directly.
3979  *	Must be atomic.
3980  * @sta_rate_tbl_update: Notifies the driver that the rate table changed. This
3981  *	is only used if the configured rate control algorithm actually uses
3982  *	the new rate table API, and is therefore optional. Must be atomic.
3983  *
3984  * @sta_statistics: Get statistics for this station. For example with beacon
3985  *	filtering, the statistics kept by mac80211 might not be accurate, so
3986  *	let the driver pre-fill the statistics. The driver can fill most of
3987  *	the values (indicating which by setting the filled bitmap), but not
3988  *	all of them make sense - see the source for which ones are possible.
3989  *	Statistics that the driver doesn't fill will be filled by mac80211.
3990  *	The callback can sleep.
3991  *
3992  * @conf_tx: Configure TX queue parameters (EDCF (aifs, cw_min, cw_max),
3993  *	bursting) for a hardware TX queue.
3994  *	Returns a negative error code on failure.
3995  *	The callback can sleep.
3996  *
3997  * @get_tsf: Get the current TSF timer value from firmware/hardware. Currently,
3998  *	this is only used for IBSS mode BSSID merging and debugging. Is not a
3999  *	required function.
4000  *	The callback can sleep.
4001  *
4002  * @set_tsf: Set the TSF timer to the specified value in the firmware/hardware.
4003  *	Currently, this is only used for IBSS mode debugging. Is not a
4004  *	required function.
4005  *	The callback can sleep.
4006  *
4007  * @offset_tsf: Offset the TSF timer by the specified value in the
4008  *	firmware/hardware.  Preferred to set_tsf as it avoids delay between
4009  *	calling set_tsf() and hardware getting programmed, which will show up
4010  *	as TSF delay. Is not a required function.
4011  *	The callback can sleep.
4012  *
4013  * @reset_tsf: Reset the TSF timer and allow firmware/hardware to synchronize
4014  *	with other STAs in the IBSS. This is only used in IBSS mode. This
4015  *	function is optional if the firmware/hardware takes full care of
4016  *	TSF synchronization.
4017  *	The callback can sleep.
4018  *
4019  * @tx_last_beacon: Determine whether the last IBSS beacon was sent by us.
4020  *	This is needed only for IBSS mode and the result of this function is
4021  *	used to determine whether to reply to Probe Requests.
4022  *	Returns non-zero if this device sent the last beacon.
4023  *	The callback can sleep.
4024  *
4025  * @get_survey: Return per-channel survey information
4026  *
4027  * @rfkill_poll: Poll rfkill hardware state. If you need this, you also
4028  *	need to set wiphy->rfkill_poll to %true before registration,
4029  *	and need to call wiphy_rfkill_set_hw_state() in the callback.
4030  *	The callback can sleep.
4031  *
4032  * @set_coverage_class: Set slot time for given coverage class as specified
4033  *	in IEEE 802.11-2007 section 17.3.8.6 and modify ACK timeout
4034  *	accordingly; coverage class equals to -1 to enable ACK timeout
4035  *	estimation algorithm (dynack). To disable dynack set valid value for
4036  *	coverage class. This callback is not required and may sleep.
4037  *
4038  * @testmode_cmd: Implement a cfg80211 test mode command. The passed @vif may
4039  *	be %NULL. The callback can sleep.
4040  * @testmode_dump: Implement a cfg80211 test mode dump. The callback can sleep.
4041  *
4042  * @flush: Flush all pending frames from the hardware queue, making sure
4043  *	that the hardware queues are empty. The @queues parameter is a bitmap
4044  *	of queues to flush, which is useful if different virtual interfaces
4045  *	use different hardware queues; it may also indicate all queues.
4046  *	If the parameter @drop is set to %true, pending frames may be dropped.
4047  *	Note that vif can be NULL.
4048  *	The callback can sleep.
4049  *
4050  * @flush_sta: Flush or drop all pending frames from the hardware queue(s) for
4051  *	the given station, as it's about to be removed.
4052  *	The callback can sleep.
4053  *
4054  * @channel_switch: Drivers that need (or want) to offload the channel
4055  *	switch operation for CSAs received from the AP may implement this
4056  *	callback. They must then call ieee80211_chswitch_done() to indicate
4057  *	completion of the channel switch.
4058  *
4059  * @set_antenna: Set antenna configuration (tx_ant, rx_ant) on the device.
4060  *	Parameters are bitmaps of allowed antennas to use for TX/RX. Drivers may
4061  *	reject TX/RX mask combinations they cannot support by returning -EINVAL
4062  *	(also see nl80211.h @NL80211_ATTR_WIPHY_ANTENNA_TX).
4063  *
4064  * @get_antenna: Get current antenna configuration from device (tx_ant, rx_ant).
4065  *
4066  * @remain_on_channel: Starts an off-channel period on the given channel, must
4067  *	call back to ieee80211_ready_on_channel() when on that channel. Note
4068  *	that normal channel traffic is not stopped as this is intended for hw
4069  *	offload. Frames to transmit on the off-channel channel are transmitted
4070  *	normally except for the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_TX_OFFCHAN flag. When the
4071  *	duration (which will always be non-zero) expires, the driver must call
4072  *	ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired().
4073  *	Note that this callback may be called while the device is in IDLE and
4074  *	must be accepted in this case.
4075  *	This callback may sleep.
4076  * @cancel_remain_on_channel: Requests that an ongoing off-channel period is
4077  *	aborted before it expires. This callback may sleep.
4078  *
4079  * @set_ringparam: Set tx and rx ring sizes.
4080  *
4081  * @get_ringparam: Get tx and rx ring current and maximum sizes.
4082  *
4083  * @tx_frames_pending: Check if there is any pending frame in the hardware
4084  *	queues before entering power save.
4085  *
4086  * @set_bitrate_mask: Set a mask of rates to be used for rate control selection
4087  *	when transmitting a frame. Currently only legacy rates are handled.
4088  *	The callback can sleep.
4089  * @event_callback: Notify driver about any event in mac80211. See
4090  *	&enum ieee80211_event_type for the different types.
4091  *	The callback must be atomic.
4092  *
4093  * @release_buffered_frames: Release buffered frames according to the given
4094  *	parameters. In the case where the driver buffers some frames for
4095  *	sleeping stations mac80211 will use this callback to tell the driver
4096  *	to release some frames, either for PS-poll or uAPSD.
4097  *	Note that if the @more_data parameter is %false the driver must check
4098  *	if there are more frames on the given TIDs, and if there are more than
4099  *	the frames being released then it must still set the more-data bit in
4100  *	the frame. If the @more_data parameter is %true, then of course the
4101  *	more-data bit must always be set.
4102  *	The @tids parameter tells the driver which TIDs to release frames
4103  *	from, for PS-poll it will always have only a single bit set.
4104  *	In the case this is used for a PS-poll initiated release, the
4105  *	@num_frames parameter will always be 1 so code can be shared. In
4106  *	this case the driver must also set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4107  *	on the TX status (and must report TX status) so that the PS-poll
4108  *	period is properly ended. This is used to avoid sending multiple
4109  *	responses for a retried PS-poll frame.
4110  *	In the case this is used for uAPSD, the @num_frames parameter may be
4111  *	bigger than one, but the driver may send fewer frames (it must send
4112  *	at least one, however). In this case it is also responsible for
4113  *	setting the EOSP flag in the QoS header of the frames. Also, when the
4114  *	service period ends, the driver must set %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP
4115  *	on the last frame in the SP. Alternatively, it may call the function
4116  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() to inform mac80211 of the end of the SP.
4117  *	This callback must be atomic.
4118  * @allow_buffered_frames: Prepare device to allow the given number of frames
4119  *	to go out to the given station. The frames will be sent by mac80211
4120  *	via the usual TX path after this call. The TX information for frames
4121  *	released will also have the %IEEE80211_TX_CTL_NO_PS_BUFFER flag set
4122  *	and the last one will also have %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP set. In case
4123  *	frames from multiple TIDs are released and the driver might reorder
4124  *	them between the TIDs, it must set the %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP flag
4125  *	on the last frame and clear it on all others and also handle the EOSP
4126  *	bit in the QoS header correctly. Alternatively, it can also call the
4127  *	ieee80211_sta_eosp() function.
4128  *	The @tids parameter is a bitmap and tells the driver which TIDs the
4129  *	frames will be on; it will at most have two bits set.
4130  *	This callback must be atomic.
4131  *
4132  * @get_et_sset_count:  Ethtool API to get string-set count.
4133  *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4134  *	expected to return a static value.
4135  *
4136  * @get_et_stats:  Ethtool API to get a set of u64 stats.
4137  *
4138  * @get_et_strings:  Ethtool API to get a set of strings to describe stats
4139  *	and perhaps other supported types of ethtool data-sets.
4140  *	Note that the wiphy mutex is not held for this callback since it's
4141  *	expected to return a static value.
4142  *
4143  * @mgd_prepare_tx: Prepare for transmitting a management frame for association
4144  *	before associated. In multi-channel scenarios, a virtual interface is
4145  *	bound to a channel before it is associated, but as it isn't associated
4146  *	yet it need not necessarily be given airtime, in particular since any
4147  *	transmission to a P2P GO needs to be synchronized against the GO's
4148  *	powersave state. mac80211 will call this function before transmitting a
4149  *	management frame prior to having successfully associated to allow the
4150  *	driver to give it channel time for the transmission, to get a response
4151  *	and to be able to synchronize with the GO.
4152  *	For drivers that set %IEEE80211_HW_DEAUTH_NEED_MGD_TX_PREP, mac80211
4153  *	would also call this function before transmitting a deauthentication
4154  *	frame in case that no beacon was heard from the AP/P2P GO.
4155  *	The callback will be called before each transmission and upon return
4156  *	mac80211 will transmit the frame right away.
4157  *	Additional information is passed in the &struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info
4158  *	data. If duration there is greater than zero, mac80211 hints to the
4159  *	driver the duration for which the operation is requested.
4160  *	The callback is optional and can (should!) sleep.
4161  * @mgd_complete_tx: Notify the driver that the response frame for a previously
4162  *	transmitted frame announced with @mgd_prepare_tx was received, the data
4163  *	is filled similarly to @mgd_prepare_tx though the duration is not used.
4164  *
4165  * @mgd_protect_tdls_discover: Protect a TDLS discovery session. After sending
4166  *	a TDLS discovery-request, we expect a reply to arrive on the AP's
4167  *	channel. We must stay on the channel (no PSM, scan, etc.), since a TDLS
4168  *	setup-response is a direct packet not buffered by the AP.
4169  *	mac80211 will call this function just before the transmission of a TDLS
4170  *	discovery-request. The recommended period of protection is at least
4171  *	2 * (DTIM period).
4172  *	The callback is optional and can sleep.
4173  *
4174  * @add_chanctx: Notifies device driver about new channel context creation.
4175  *	This callback may sleep.
4176  * @remove_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context destruction.
4177  *	This callback may sleep.
4178  * @change_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context changes that
4179  *	may happen when combining different virtual interfaces on the same
4180  *	channel context with different settings
4181  *	This callback may sleep.
4182  * @assign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being bound
4183  *	to vif. Possible use is for hw queue remapping.
4184  *	This callback may sleep.
4185  * @unassign_vif_chanctx: Notifies device driver about channel context being
4186  *	unbound from vif.
4187  *	This callback may sleep.
4188  * @switch_vif_chanctx: switch a number of vifs from one chanctx to
4189  *	another, as specified in the list of
4190  *	@ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch passed to the driver, according
4191  *	to the mode defined in &ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode.
4192  *	This callback may sleep.
4193  *
4194  * @start_ap: Start operation on the AP interface, this is called after all the
4195  *	information in bss_conf is set and beacon can be retrieved. A channel
4196  *	context is bound before this is called. Note that if the driver uses
4197  *	software scan or ROC, this (and @stop_ap) isn't called when the AP is
4198  *	just "paused" for scanning/ROC, which is indicated by the beacon being
4199  *	disabled/enabled via @bss_info_changed.
4200  * @stop_ap: Stop operation on the AP interface.
4201  *
4202  * @reconfig_complete: Called after a call to ieee80211_restart_hw() and
4203  *	during resume, when the reconfiguration has completed.
4204  *	This can help the driver implement the reconfiguration step (and
4205  *	indicate mac80211 is ready to receive frames).
4206  *	This callback may sleep.
4207  *
4208  * @ipv6_addr_change: IPv6 address assignment on the given interface changed.
4209  *	Currently, this is only called for managed or P2P client interfaces.
4210  *	This callback is optional; it must not sleep.
4211  *
4212  * @channel_switch_beacon: Starts a channel switch to a new channel.
4213  *	Beacons are modified to include CSA or ECSA IEs before calling this
4214  *	function. The corresponding count fields in these IEs must be
4215  *	decremented, and when they reach 1 the driver must call
4216  *	ieee80211_csa_finish(). Drivers which use ieee80211_beacon_get()
4217  *	get the csa counter decremented by mac80211, but must check if it is
4218  *	1 using ieee80211_beacon_counter_is_complete() after the beacon has been
4219  *	transmitted and then call ieee80211_csa_finish().
4220  *	If the CSA count starts as zero or 1, this function will not be called,
4221  *	since there won't be any time to beacon before the switch anyway.
4222  * @pre_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4223  *	before a channel switch procedure is started (ie. when a STA
4224  *	gets a CSA or a userspace initiated channel-switch), allowing
4225  *	the driver to prepare for the channel switch.
4226  * @post_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4227  *	after a channel switch procedure is completed, allowing the
4228  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4229  * @abort_channel_switch: This is an optional callback that is called
4230  *	when channel switch procedure was completed, allowing the
4231  *	driver to go back to a normal configuration.
4232  * @channel_switch_rx_beacon: This is an optional callback that is called
4233  *	when channel switch procedure is in progress and additional beacon with
4234  *	CSA IE was received, allowing driver to track changes in count.
4235  * @join_ibss: Join an IBSS (on an IBSS interface); this is called after all
4236  *	information in bss_conf is set up and the beacon can be retrieved. A
4237  *	channel context is bound before this is called.
4238  * @leave_ibss: Leave the IBSS again.
4239  *
4240  * @get_expected_throughput: extract the expected throughput towards the
4241  *	specified station. The returned value is expressed in Kbps. It returns 0
4242  *	if the RC algorithm does not have proper data to provide.
4243  *
4244  * @get_txpower: get current maximum tx power (in dBm) based on configuration
4245  *	and hardware limits.
4246  *
4247  * @tdls_channel_switch: Start channel-switching with a TDLS peer. The driver
4248  *	is responsible for continually initiating channel-switching operations
4249  *	and returning to the base channel for communication with the AP. The
4250  *	driver receives a channel-switch request template and the location of
4251  *	the switch-timing IE within the template as part of the invocation.
4252  *	The template is valid only within the call, and the driver can
4253  *	optionally copy the skb for further re-use.
4254  * @tdls_cancel_channel_switch: Stop channel-switching with a TDLS peer. Both
4255  *	peers must be on the base channel when the call completes.
4256  * @tdls_recv_channel_switch: a TDLS channel-switch related frame (request or
4257  *	response) has been received from a remote peer. The driver gets
4258  *	parameters parsed from the incoming frame and may use them to continue
4259  *	an ongoing channel-switch operation. In addition, a channel-switch
4260  *	response template is provided, together with the location of the
4261  *	switch-timing IE within the template. The skb can only be used within
4262  *	the function call.
4263  *
4264  * @wake_tx_queue: Called when new packets have been added to the queue.
4265  * @sync_rx_queues: Process all pending frames in RSS queues. This is a
4266  *	synchronization which is needed in case driver has in its RSS queues
4267  *	pending frames that were received prior to the control path action
4268  *	currently taken (e.g. disassociation) but are not processed yet.
4269  *
4270  * @start_nan: join an existing NAN cluster, or create a new one.
4271  * @stop_nan: leave the NAN cluster.
4272  * @nan_change_conf: change NAN configuration. The data in cfg80211_nan_conf
4273  *	contains full new configuration and changes specify which parameters
4274  *	are changed with respect to the last NAN config.
4275  *	The driver gets both full configuration and the changed parameters since
4276  *	some devices may need the full configuration while others need only the
4277  *	changed parameters.
4278  * @add_nan_func: Add a NAN function. Returns 0 on success. The data in
4279  *	cfg80211_nan_func must not be referenced outside the scope of
4280  *	this call.
4281  * @del_nan_func: Remove a NAN function. The driver must call
4282  *	ieee80211_nan_func_terminated() with
4283  *	NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_USER_REQUEST reason code upon removal.
4284  * @can_aggregate_in_amsdu: Called in order to determine if HW supports
4285  *	aggregating two specific frames in the same A-MSDU. The relation
4286  *	between the skbs should be symmetric and transitive. Note that while
4287  *	skb is always a real frame, head may or may not be an A-MSDU.
4288  * @get_ftm_responder_stats: Retrieve FTM responder statistics, if available.
4289  *	Statistics should be cumulative, currently no way to reset is provided.
4290  *
4291  * @start_pmsr: start peer measurement (e.g. FTM) (this call can sleep)
4292  * @abort_pmsr: abort peer measurement (this call can sleep)
4293  * @set_tid_config: Apply TID specific configurations. This callback may sleep.
4294  * @reset_tid_config: Reset TID specific configuration for the peer.
4295  *	This callback may sleep.
4296  * @update_vif_offload: Update virtual interface offload flags
4297  *	This callback may sleep.
4298  * @sta_set_4addr: Called to notify the driver when a station starts/stops using
4299  *	4-address mode
4300  * @set_sar_specs: Update the SAR (TX power) settings.
4301  * @sta_set_decap_offload: Called to notify the driver when a station is allowed
4302  *	to use rx decapsulation offload
4303  * @add_twt_setup: Update hw with TWT agreement parameters received from the peer.
4304  *	This callback allows the hw to check if requested parameters
4305  *	are supported and if there is enough room for a new agreement.
4306  *	The hw is expected to set agreement result in the req_type field of
4307  *	twt structure.
4308  * @twt_teardown_request: Update the hw with TWT teardown request received
4309  *	from the peer.
4310  * @set_radar_background: Configure dedicated offchannel chain available for
4311  *	radar/CAC detection on some hw. This chain can't be used to transmit
4312  *	or receive frames and it is bounded to a running wdev.
4313  *	Background radar/CAC detection allows to avoid the CAC downtime
4314  *	switching to a different channel during CAC detection on the selected
4315  *	radar channel.
4316  *	The caller is expected to set chandef pointer to NULL in order to
4317  *	disable background CAC/radar detection.
4318  * @net_fill_forward_path: Called from .ndo_fill_forward_path in order to
4319  *	resolve a path for hardware flow offloading
4320  * @can_activate_links: Checks if a specific active_links bitmap is
4321  *	supported by the driver.
4322  * @change_vif_links: Change the valid links on an interface, note that while
4323  *	removing the old link information is still valid (link_conf pointer),
4324  *	but may immediately disappear after the function returns. The old or
4325  *	new links bitmaps may be 0 if going from/to a non-MLO situation.
4326  *	The @old array contains pointers to the old bss_conf structures
4327  *	that were already removed, in case they're needed.
4328  *	This callback can sleep.
4329  * @change_sta_links: Change the valid links of a station, similar to
4330  *	@change_vif_links. This callback can sleep.
4331  *	Note that a sta can also be inserted or removed with valid links,
4332  *	i.e. passed to @sta_add/@sta_state with sta->valid_links not zero.
4333  *	In fact, cannot change from having valid_links and not having them.
4334  * @set_hw_timestamp: Enable/disable HW timestamping of TM/FTM frames. This is
4335  *	not restored at HW reset by mac80211 so drivers need to take care of
4336  *	that.
4337  * @net_setup_tc: Called from .ndo_setup_tc in order to prepare hardware
4338  *	flow offloading for flows originating from the vif.
4339  *	Note that the driver must not assume that the vif driver_data is valid
4340  *	at this point, since the callback can be called during netdev teardown.
4341  * @can_neg_ttlm: for managed interface, requests the driver to determine
4342  *	if the requested TID-To-Link mapping can be accepted or not.
4343  *	If it's not accepted the driver may suggest a preferred mapping and
4344  *	modify @ttlm parameter with the suggested TID-to-Link mapping.
4345  */
4346 struct ieee80211_ops {
4347 	void (*tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4348 		   struct ieee80211_tx_control *control,
4349 		   struct sk_buff *skb);
4350 	int (*start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4351 	void (*stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4352 #ifdef CONFIG_PM
4353 	int (*suspend)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct cfg80211_wowlan *wowlan);
4354 	int (*resume)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4355 	void (*set_wakeup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, bool enabled);
4356 #endif
4357 	int (*add_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4358 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4359 	int (*change_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4360 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4361 				enum nl80211_iftype new_type, bool p2p);
4362 	void (*remove_interface)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4363 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4364 	int (*config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 changed);
4365 	void (*bss_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4366 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4367 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4368 				 u64 changed);
4369 	void (*vif_cfg_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4370 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4371 				u64 changed);
4372 	void (*link_info_changed)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4373 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4374 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *info,
4375 				  u64 changed);
4376 
4377 	int (*start_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4378 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4379 	void (*stop_ap)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4380 			struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4381 
4382 	u64 (*prepare_multicast)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4383 				 struct netdev_hw_addr_list *mc_list);
4384 	void (*configure_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4385 				 unsigned int changed_flags,
4386 				 unsigned int *total_flags,
4387 				 u64 multicast);
4388 	void (*config_iface_filter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4389 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4390 				    unsigned int filter_flags,
4391 				    unsigned int changed_flags);
4392 	int (*set_tim)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4393 		       bool set);
4394 	int (*set_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, enum set_key_cmd cmd,
4395 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4396 		       struct ieee80211_key_conf *key);
4397 	void (*update_tkip_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4398 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4399 				struct ieee80211_key_conf *conf,
4400 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4401 				u32 iv32, u16 *phase1key);
4402 	void (*set_rekey_data)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4403 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4404 			       struct cfg80211_gtk_rekey_data *data);
4405 	void (*set_default_unicast_key)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4406 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int idx);
4407 	int (*hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4408 		       struct ieee80211_scan_request *req);
4409 	void (*cancel_hw_scan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4410 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4411 	int (*sched_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4412 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4413 				struct cfg80211_sched_scan_request *req,
4414 				struct ieee80211_scan_ies *ies);
4415 	int (*sched_scan_stop)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4416 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4417 	void (*sw_scan_start)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4418 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4419 			      const u8 *mac_addr);
4420 	void (*sw_scan_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4421 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4422 	int (*get_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4423 			 struct ieee80211_low_level_stats *stats);
4424 	void (*get_key_seq)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4425 			    struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
4426 			    struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
4427 	int (*set_frag_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4428 	int (*set_rts_threshold)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 value);
4429 	int (*sta_add)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4430 		       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4431 	int (*sta_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4432 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4433 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_DEBUGFS
4434 	void (*vif_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4435 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4436 	void (*link_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4437 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4438 				 struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4439 				 struct dentry *dir);
4440 	void (*sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4441 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4442 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4443 				struct dentry *dir);
4444 	void (*link_sta_add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4445 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4446 				     struct ieee80211_link_sta *link_sta,
4447 				     struct dentry *dir);
4448 #endif
4449 	void (*sta_notify)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4450 			enum sta_notify_cmd, struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4451 	int (*sta_set_txpwr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4452 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4453 			     struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4454 	int (*sta_state)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4455 			 struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4456 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state old_state,
4457 			 enum ieee80211_sta_state new_state);
4458 	void (*sta_pre_rcu_remove)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4459 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4460 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4461 	void (*sta_rc_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4462 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4463 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4464 			      u32 changed);
4465 	void (*sta_rate_tbl_update)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4466 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4467 				    struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4468 	void (*sta_statistics)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4469 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4470 			       struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4471 			       struct station_info *sinfo);
4472 	int (*conf_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4473 		       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4474 		       unsigned int link_id, u16 ac,
4475 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_queue_params *params);
4476 	u64 (*get_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4477 	void (*set_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4478 			u64 tsf);
4479 	void (*offset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4480 			   s64 offset);
4481 	void (*reset_tsf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4482 	int (*tx_last_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4483 
4484 	/**
4485 	 * @ampdu_action:
4486 	 * Perform a certain A-MPDU action.
4487 	 * The RA/TID combination determines the destination and TID we want
4488 	 * the ampdu action to be performed for. The action is defined through
4489 	 * ieee80211_ampdu_mlme_action.
4490 	 * When the action is set to %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_OPERATIONAL the driver
4491 	 * may neither send aggregates containing more subframes than @buf_size
4492 	 * nor send aggregates in a way that lost frames would exceed the
4493 	 * buffer size. If just limiting the aggregate size, this would be
4494 	 * possible with a buf_size of 8:
4495 	 *
4496 	 * - ``TX: 1.....7``
4497 	 * - ``RX:  2....7`` (lost frame #1)
4498 	 * - ``TX:        8..1...``
4499 	 *
4500 	 * which is invalid since #1 was now re-transmitted well past the
4501 	 * buffer size of 8. Correct ways to retransmit #1 would be:
4502 	 *
4503 	 * - ``TX:        1   or``
4504 	 * - ``TX:        18  or``
4505 	 * - ``TX:        81``
4506 	 *
4507 	 * Even ``189`` would be wrong since 1 could be lost again.
4508 	 *
4509 	 * Returns a negative error code on failure. The driver may return
4510 	 * %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START_IMMEDIATE for %IEEE80211_AMPDU_TX_START
4511 	 * if the session can start immediately.
4512 	 *
4513 	 * The callback can sleep.
4514 	 */
4515 	int (*ampdu_action)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4516 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4517 			    struct ieee80211_ampdu_params *params);
4518 	int (*get_survey)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int idx,
4519 		struct survey_info *survey);
4520 	void (*rfkill_poll)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4521 	void (*set_coverage_class)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, s16 coverage_class);
4522 #ifdef CONFIG_NL80211_TESTMODE
4523 	int (*testmode_cmd)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4524 			    void *data, int len);
4525 	int (*testmode_dump)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb,
4526 			     struct netlink_callback *cb,
4527 			     void *data, int len);
4528 #endif
4529 	void (*flush)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4530 		      u32 queues, bool drop);
4531 	void (*flush_sta)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4532 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4533 	void (*channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4534 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4535 			       struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4536 	int (*set_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx_ant, u32 rx_ant);
4537 	int (*get_antenna)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 *tx_ant, u32 *rx_ant);
4538 
4539 	int (*remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4540 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4541 				 struct ieee80211_channel *chan,
4542 				 int duration,
4543 				 enum ieee80211_roc_type type);
4544 	int (*cancel_remain_on_channel)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4545 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4546 	int (*set_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 tx, u32 rx);
4547 	void (*get_ringparam)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4548 			      u32 *tx, u32 *tx_max, u32 *rx, u32 *rx_max);
4549 	bool (*tx_frames_pending)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4550 	int (*set_bitrate_mask)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4551 				const struct cfg80211_bitrate_mask *mask);
4552 	void (*event_callback)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4553 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4554 			       const struct ieee80211_event *event);
4555 
4556 	void (*allow_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4557 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4558 				      u16 tids, int num_frames,
4559 				      enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4560 				      bool more_data);
4561 	void (*release_buffered_frames)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4562 					struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4563 					u16 tids, int num_frames,
4564 					enum ieee80211_frame_release_type reason,
4565 					bool more_data);
4566 
4567 	int	(*get_et_sset_count)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4568 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif, int sset);
4569 	void	(*get_et_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4570 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4571 				struct ethtool_stats *stats, u64 *data);
4572 	void	(*get_et_strings)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4573 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4574 				  u32 sset, u8 *data);
4575 
4576 	void	(*mgd_prepare_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4577 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4578 				  struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4579 	void	(*mgd_complete_tx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4580 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4581 				   struct ieee80211_prep_tx_info *info);
4582 
4583 	void	(*mgd_protect_tdls_discover)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4584 					     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4585 					     unsigned int link_id);
4586 
4587 	int (*add_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4588 			   struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4589 	void (*remove_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4590 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4591 	void (*change_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4592 			       struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx,
4593 			       u32 changed);
4594 	int (*assign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4595 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4596 				  struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4597 				  struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4598 	void (*unassign_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4599 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4600 				     struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf,
4601 				     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *ctx);
4602 	int (*switch_vif_chanctx)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4603 				  struct ieee80211_vif_chanctx_switch *vifs,
4604 				  int n_vifs,
4605 				  enum ieee80211_chanctx_switch_mode mode);
4606 
4607 	void (*reconfig_complete)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4608 				  enum ieee80211_reconfig_type reconfig_type);
4609 
4610 #if IS_ENABLED(CONFIG_IPV6)
4611 	void (*ipv6_addr_change)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4612 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4613 				 struct inet6_dev *idev);
4614 #endif
4615 	void (*channel_switch_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4616 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4617 				      struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4618 	int (*pre_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4619 				  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4620 				  struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4621 
4622 	int (*post_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4623 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4624 				   struct ieee80211_bss_conf *link_conf);
4625 	void (*abort_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4626 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4627 	void (*channel_switch_rx_beacon)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4628 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4629 					 struct ieee80211_channel_switch *ch_switch);
4630 
4631 	int (*join_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4632 	void (*leave_ibss)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4633 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4634 				       struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4635 	int (*get_txpower)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4636 			   int *dbm);
4637 
4638 	int (*tdls_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4639 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4640 				   struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 oper_class,
4641 				   struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
4642 				   struct sk_buff *tmpl_skb, u32 ch_sw_tm_ie);
4643 	void (*tdls_cancel_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4644 					   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4645 					   struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
4646 	void (*tdls_recv_channel_switch)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4647 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4648 					 struct ieee80211_tdls_ch_sw_params *params);
4649 
4650 	void (*wake_tx_queue)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4651 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
4652 	void (*sync_rx_queues)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4653 
4654 	int (*start_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4655 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4656 			 struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf);
4657 	int (*stop_nan)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4658 			struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4659 	int (*nan_change_conf)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4660 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4661 			       struct cfg80211_nan_conf *conf, u32 changes);
4662 	int (*add_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4663 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4664 			    const struct cfg80211_nan_func *nan_func);
4665 	void (*del_nan_func)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4666 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4667 			    u8 instance_id);
4668 	bool (*can_aggregate_in_amsdu)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4669 				       struct sk_buff *head,
4670 				       struct sk_buff *skb);
4671 	int (*get_ftm_responder_stats)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4672 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4673 				       struct cfg80211_ftm_responder_stats *ftm_stats);
4674 	int (*start_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4675 			  struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4676 	void (*abort_pmsr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4677 			   struct cfg80211_pmsr_request *request);
4678 	int (*set_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4679 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4680 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4681 			      struct cfg80211_tid_config *tid_conf);
4682 	int (*reset_tid_config)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4683 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4684 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tids);
4685 	void (*update_vif_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4686 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
4687 	void (*sta_set_4addr)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4688 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4689 	int (*set_sar_specs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4690 			     const struct cfg80211_sar_specs *sar);
4691 	void (*sta_set_decap_offload)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4692 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4693 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool enabled);
4694 	void (*add_twt_setup)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4695 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4696 			      struct ieee80211_twt_setup *twt);
4697 	void (*twt_teardown_request)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4698 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 flowid);
4699 	int (*set_radar_background)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4700 				    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef);
4701 	int (*net_fill_forward_path)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4702 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4703 				     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4704 				     struct net_device_path_ctx *ctx,
4705 				     struct net_device_path *path);
4706 	bool (*can_activate_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4707 				   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4708 				   u16 active_links);
4709 	int (*change_vif_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4710 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4711 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links,
4712 				struct ieee80211_bss_conf *old[IEEE80211_MLD_MAX_NUM_LINKS]);
4713 	int (*change_sta_links)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4714 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4715 				struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4716 				u16 old_links, u16 new_links);
4717 	int (*set_hw_timestamp)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4718 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4719 				struct cfg80211_set_hw_timestamp *hwts);
4720 	int (*net_setup_tc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4721 			    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4722 			    struct net_device *dev,
4723 			    enum tc_setup_type type,
4724 			    void *type_data);
4725 	enum ieee80211_neg_ttlm_res
4726 	(*can_neg_ttlm)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
4727 			struct ieee80211_neg_ttlm *ttlm);
4728 };
4729 
4730 /**
4731  * ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm - Allocate a new hardware device
4732  *
4733  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4734  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4735  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4736  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4737  * @priv_data_len.
4738  *
4739  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4740  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4741  * @requested_name: Requested name for this device.
4742  *	NULL is valid value, and means use the default naming (phy%d)
4743  *
4744  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4745  */
4746 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(size_t priv_data_len,
4747 					   const struct ieee80211_ops *ops,
4748 					   const char *requested_name);
4749 
4750 /**
4751  * ieee80211_alloc_hw - Allocate a new hardware device
4752  *
4753  * This must be called once for each hardware device. The returned pointer
4754  * must be used to refer to this device when calling other functions.
4755  * mac80211 allocates a private data area for the driver pointed to by
4756  * @priv in &struct ieee80211_hw, the size of this area is given as
4757  * @priv_data_len.
4758  *
4759  * @priv_data_len: length of private data
4760  * @ops: callbacks for this device
4761  *
4762  * Return: A pointer to the new hardware device, or %NULL on error.
4763  */
4764 static inline
4765 struct ieee80211_hw *ieee80211_alloc_hw(size_t priv_data_len,
4766 					const struct ieee80211_ops *ops)
4767 {
4768 	return ieee80211_alloc_hw_nm(priv_data_len, ops, NULL);
4769 }
4770 
4771 /**
4772  * ieee80211_register_hw - Register hardware device
4773  *
4774  * You must call this function before any other functions in
4775  * mac80211. Note that before a hardware can be registered, you
4776  * need to fill the contained wiphy's information.
4777  *
4778  * @hw: the device to register as returned by ieee80211_alloc_hw()
4779  *
4780  * Return: 0 on success. An error code otherwise.
4781  */
4782 int ieee80211_register_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4783 
4784 /**
4785  * struct ieee80211_tpt_blink - throughput blink description
4786  * @throughput: throughput in Kbit/sec
4787  * @blink_time: blink time in milliseconds
4788  *	(full cycle, ie. one off + one on period)
4789  */
4790 struct ieee80211_tpt_blink {
4791 	int throughput;
4792 	int blink_time;
4793 };
4794 
4795 /**
4796  * enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags - throughput trigger flags
4797  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO: enable blinking with radio
4798  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK: enable blinking when working
4799  * @IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED: enable blinking when at least one
4800  *	interface is connected in some way, including being an AP
4801  */
4802 enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags {
4803 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_RADIO		= BIT(0),
4804 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_WORK		= BIT(1),
4805 	IEEE80211_TPT_LEDTRIG_FL_CONNECTED	= BIT(2),
4806 };
4807 
4808 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4809 const char *__ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4810 const char *__ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4811 const char *__ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4812 const char *__ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4813 const char *
4814 __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
4815 				   unsigned int flags,
4816 				   const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4817 				   unsigned int blink_table_len);
4818 #endif
4819 /**
4820  * ieee80211_get_tx_led_name - get name of TX LED
4821  *
4822  * mac80211 creates a transmit LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4823  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4824  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4825  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4826  *
4827  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4828  *
4829  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4830  */
4831 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4832 {
4833 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4834 	return __ieee80211_get_tx_led_name(hw);
4835 #else
4836 	return NULL;
4837 #endif
4838 }
4839 
4840 /**
4841  * ieee80211_get_rx_led_name - get name of RX LED
4842  *
4843  * mac80211 creates a receive LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4844  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4845  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4846  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4847  *
4848  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4849  *
4850  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4851  */
4852 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4853 {
4854 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4855 	return __ieee80211_get_rx_led_name(hw);
4856 #else
4857 	return NULL;
4858 #endif
4859 }
4860 
4861 /**
4862  * ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name - get name of association LED
4863  *
4864  * mac80211 creates a association LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4865  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4866  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4867  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4868  *
4869  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4870  *
4871  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4872  */
4873 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4874 {
4875 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4876 	return __ieee80211_get_assoc_led_name(hw);
4877 #else
4878 	return NULL;
4879 #endif
4880 }
4881 
4882 /**
4883  * ieee80211_get_radio_led_name - get name of radio LED
4884  *
4885  * mac80211 creates a radio change LED trigger for each wireless hardware
4886  * that can be used to drive LEDs if your driver registers a LED device.
4887  * This function returns the name (or %NULL if not configured for LEDs)
4888  * of the trigger so you can automatically link the LED device.
4889  *
4890  * @hw: the hardware to get the LED trigger name for
4891  *
4892  * Return: The name of the LED trigger. %NULL if not configured for LEDs.
4893  */
4894 static inline const char *ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(struct ieee80211_hw *hw)
4895 {
4896 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4897 	return __ieee80211_get_radio_led_name(hw);
4898 #else
4899 	return NULL;
4900 #endif
4901 }
4902 
4903 /**
4904  * ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger - create throughput LED trigger
4905  * @hw: the hardware to create the trigger for
4906  * @flags: trigger flags, see &enum ieee80211_tpt_led_trigger_flags
4907  * @blink_table: the blink table -- needs to be ordered by throughput
4908  * @blink_table_len: size of the blink table
4909  *
4910  * Return: %NULL (in case of error, or if no LED triggers are
4911  * configured) or the name of the new trigger.
4912  *
4913  * Note: This function must be called before ieee80211_register_hw().
4914  */
4915 static inline const char *
4916 ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, unsigned int flags,
4917 				 const struct ieee80211_tpt_blink *blink_table,
4918 				 unsigned int blink_table_len)
4919 {
4920 #ifdef CONFIG_MAC80211_LEDS
4921 	return __ieee80211_create_tpt_led_trigger(hw, flags, blink_table,
4922 						  blink_table_len);
4923 #else
4924 	return NULL;
4925 #endif
4926 }
4927 
4928 /**
4929  * ieee80211_unregister_hw - Unregister a hardware device
4930  *
4931  * This function instructs mac80211 to free allocated resources
4932  * and unregister netdevices from the networking subsystem.
4933  *
4934  * @hw: the hardware to unregister
4935  */
4936 void ieee80211_unregister_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4937 
4938 /**
4939  * ieee80211_free_hw - free hardware descriptor
4940  *
4941  * This function frees everything that was allocated, including the
4942  * private data for the driver. You must call ieee80211_unregister_hw()
4943  * before calling this function.
4944  *
4945  * @hw: the hardware to free
4946  */
4947 void ieee80211_free_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4948 
4949 /**
4950  * ieee80211_restart_hw - restart hardware completely
4951  *
4952  * Call this function when the hardware was restarted for some reason
4953  * (hardware error, ...) and the driver is unable to restore its state
4954  * by itself. mac80211 assumes that at this point the driver/hardware
4955  * is completely uninitialised and stopped, it starts the process by
4956  * calling the ->start() operation. The driver will need to reset all
4957  * internal state that it has prior to calling this function.
4958  *
4959  * @hw: the hardware to restart
4960  */
4961 void ieee80211_restart_hw(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
4962 
4963 /**
4964  * ieee80211_rx_list - receive frame and store processed skbs in a list
4965  *
4966  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4967  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4968  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4969  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4970  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4971  *
4972  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4973  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4974  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
4975  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
4976  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
4977  *
4978  * This function must be called with BHs disabled and RCU read lock
4979  *
4980  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
4981  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
4982  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
4983  * @list: the destination list
4984  */
4985 void ieee80211_rx_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
4986 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct list_head *list);
4987 
4988 /**
4989  * ieee80211_rx_napi - receive frame from NAPI context
4990  *
4991  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
4992  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
4993  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
4994  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
4995  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
4996  *
4997  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
4998  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
4999  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5000  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5001  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5002  *
5003  * This function must be called with BHs disabled.
5004  *
5005  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5006  * @sta: the station the frame was received from, or %NULL
5007  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5008  * @napi: the NAPI context
5009  */
5010 void ieee80211_rx_napi(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5011 		       struct sk_buff *skb, struct napi_struct *napi);
5012 
5013 /**
5014  * ieee80211_rx - receive frame
5015  *
5016  * Use this function to hand received frames to mac80211. The receive
5017  * buffer in @skb must start with an IEEE 802.11 header. In case of a
5018  * paged @skb is used, the driver is recommended to put the ieee80211
5019  * header of the frame on the linear part of the @skb to avoid memory
5020  * allocation and/or memcpy by the stack.
5021  *
5022  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5023  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls to
5024  * this function, ieee80211_rx_ni() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may not be
5025  * mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5026  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5027  *
5028  * In process context use instead ieee80211_rx_ni().
5029  *
5030  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5031  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5032  */
5033 static inline void ieee80211_rx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb)
5034 {
5035 	ieee80211_rx_napi(hw, NULL, skb, NULL);
5036 }
5037 
5038 /**
5039  * ieee80211_rx_irqsafe - receive frame
5040  *
5041  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in IRQ context
5042  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5043  *
5044  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni() may not
5045  * be mixed for a single hardware.Must not run concurrently with
5046  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5047  *
5048  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5049  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5050  */
5051 void ieee80211_rx_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct sk_buff *skb);
5052 
5053 /**
5054  * ieee80211_rx_ni - receive frame (in process context)
5055  *
5056  * Like ieee80211_rx() but can be called in process context
5057  * (internally disables bottom halves).
5058  *
5059  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_rx() and ieee80211_rx_irqsafe() may
5060  * not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5061  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb() or ieee80211_tx_status_ni().
5062  *
5063  * @hw: the hardware this frame came in on
5064  * @skb: the buffer to receive, owned by mac80211 after this call
5065  */
5066 static inline void ieee80211_rx_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5067 				   struct sk_buff *skb)
5068 {
5069 	local_bh_disable();
5070 	ieee80211_rx(hw, skb);
5071 	local_bh_enable();
5072 }
5073 
5074 /**
5075  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition - PS transition for connected sta
5076  *
5077  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS
5078  * flag set, use this function to inform mac80211 about a connected station
5079  * entering/leaving PS mode.
5080  *
5081  * This function may not be called in IRQ context or with softirqs enabled.
5082  *
5083  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized against
5084  * each other.
5085  *
5086  * @sta: currently connected sta
5087  * @start: start or stop PS
5088  *
5089  * Return: 0 on success. -EINVAL when the requested PS mode is already set.
5090  */
5091 int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, bool start);
5092 
5093 /**
5094  * ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni - PS transition for connected sta
5095  *                                  (in process context)
5096  *
5097  * Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition() but can be called in process context
5098  * (internally disables bottom halves). Concurrent call restriction still
5099  * applies.
5100  *
5101  * @sta: currently connected sta
5102  * @start: start or stop PS
5103  *
5104  * Return: Like ieee80211_sta_ps_transition().
5105  */
5106 static inline int ieee80211_sta_ps_transition_ni(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5107 						  bool start)
5108 {
5109 	int ret;
5110 
5111 	local_bh_disable();
5112 	ret = ieee80211_sta_ps_transition(sta, start);
5113 	local_bh_enable();
5114 
5115 	return ret;
5116 }
5117 
5118 /**
5119  * ieee80211_sta_pspoll - PS-Poll frame received
5120  * @sta: currently connected station
5121  *
5122  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5123  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a PS-Poll frame from a
5124  * connected station was received.
5125  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5126  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(); calls to all three must
5127  * be serialized.
5128  */
5129 void ieee80211_sta_pspoll(struct ieee80211_sta *sta);
5130 
5131 /**
5132  * ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger - (potential) U-APSD trigger frame received
5133  * @sta: currently connected station
5134  * @tid: TID of the received (potential) trigger frame
5135  *
5136  * When operating in AP mode with the %IEEE80211_HW_AP_LINK_PS flag set,
5137  * use this function to inform mac80211 that a (potential) trigger frame
5138  * from a connected station was received.
5139  * This must be used in conjunction with ieee80211_sta_ps_transition()
5140  * and possibly ieee80211_sta_pspoll(); calls to all three must be
5141  * serialized.
5142  * %IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS can be passed as the tid if the tid is unknown.
5143  * In this case, mac80211 will not check that this tid maps to an AC
5144  * that is trigger enabled and assume that the caller did the proper
5145  * checks.
5146  */
5147 void ieee80211_sta_uapsd_trigger(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
5148 
5149 /*
5150  * The TX headroom reserved by mac80211 for its own tx_status functions.
5151  * This is enough for the radiotap header.
5152  */
5153 #define IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_HEADROOM	ALIGN(14, 4)
5154 
5155 /**
5156  * ieee80211_sta_set_buffered - inform mac80211 about driver-buffered frames
5157  * @sta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer for the sleeping station
5158  * @tid: the TID that has buffered frames
5159  * @buffered: indicates whether or not frames are buffered for this TID
5160  *
5161  * If a driver buffers frames for a powersave station instead of passing
5162  * them back to mac80211 for retransmission, the station may still need
5163  * to be told that there are buffered frames via the TIM bit.
5164  *
5165  * This function informs mac80211 whether or not there are frames that are
5166  * buffered in the driver for a given TID; mac80211 can then use this data
5167  * to set the TIM bit (NOTE: This may call back into the driver's set_tim
5168  * call! Beware of the locking!)
5169  *
5170  * If all frames are released to the station (due to PS-poll or uAPSD)
5171  * then the driver needs to inform mac80211 that there no longer are
5172  * frames buffered. However, when the station wakes up mac80211 assumes
5173  * that all buffered frames will be transmitted and clears this data,
5174  * drivers need to make sure they inform mac80211 about all buffered
5175  * frames on the sleep transition (sta_notify() with %STA_NOTIFY_SLEEP).
5176  *
5177  * Note that technically mac80211 only needs to know this per AC, not per
5178  * TID, but since driver buffering will inevitably happen per TID (since
5179  * it is related to aggregation) it is easier to make mac80211 map the
5180  * TID to the AC as required instead of keeping track in all drivers that
5181  * use this API.
5182  */
5183 void ieee80211_sta_set_buffered(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5184 				u8 tid, bool buffered);
5185 
5186 /**
5187  * ieee80211_get_tx_rates - get the selected transmit rates for a packet
5188  *
5189  * Call this function in a driver with per-packet rate selection support
5190  * to combine the rate info in the packet tx info with the most recent
5191  * rate selection table for the station entry.
5192  *
5193  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5194  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent.
5195  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
5196  * @dest: buffer for extracted rate/retry information
5197  * @max_rates: maximum number of rates to fetch
5198  */
5199 void ieee80211_get_tx_rates(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5200 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5201 			    struct sk_buff *skb,
5202 			    struct ieee80211_tx_rate *dest,
5203 			    int max_rates);
5204 
5205 /**
5206  * ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput - set the expected tpt for a station
5207  *
5208  * Call this function to notify mac80211 about a change in expected throughput
5209  * to a station. A driver for a device that does rate control in firmware can
5210  * call this function when the expected throughput estimate towards a station
5211  * changes. The information is used to tune the CoDel AQM applied to traffic
5212  * going towards that station (which can otherwise be too aggressive and cause
5213  * slow stations to starve).
5214  *
5215  * @pubsta: the station to set throughput for.
5216  * @thr: the current expected throughput in kbps.
5217  */
5218 void ieee80211_sta_set_expected_throughput(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5219 					   u32 thr);
5220 
5221 /**
5222  * ieee80211_tx_rate_update - transmit rate update callback
5223  *
5224  * Drivers should call this functions with a non-NULL pub sta
5225  * This function can be used in drivers that does not have provision
5226  * in updating the tx rate in data path.
5227  *
5228  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5229  * @pubsta: the station to update the tx rate for.
5230  * @info: tx status information
5231  */
5232 void ieee80211_tx_rate_update(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5233 			      struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
5234 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info);
5235 
5236 /**
5237  * ieee80211_tx_status_skb - transmit status callback
5238  *
5239  * Call this function for all transmitted frames after they have been
5240  * transmitted. It is permissible to not call this function for
5241  * multicast frames but this can affect statistics.
5242  *
5243  * This function may not be called in IRQ context. Calls to this function
5244  * for a single hardware must be synchronized against each other. Calls
5245  * to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni() and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe()
5246  * may not be mixed for a single hardware. Must not run concurrently with
5247  * ieee80211_rx() or ieee80211_rx_ni().
5248  *
5249  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5250  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5251  */
5252 void ieee80211_tx_status_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5253 			     struct sk_buff *skb);
5254 
5255 /**
5256  * ieee80211_tx_status_ext - extended transmit status callback
5257  *
5258  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5259  * in drivers that may want to provide extra information that does not
5260  * fit into &struct ieee80211_tx_info.
5261  *
5262  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5263  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5264  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5265  *
5266  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5267  * @status: tx status information
5268  */
5269 void ieee80211_tx_status_ext(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5270 			     struct ieee80211_tx_status *status);
5271 
5272 /**
5273  * ieee80211_tx_status_noskb - transmit status callback without skb
5274  *
5275  * This function can be used as a replacement for ieee80211_tx_status_skb()
5276  * in drivers that cannot reliably map tx status information back to
5277  * specific skbs.
5278  *
5279  * Calls to this function for a single hardware must be synchronized
5280  * against each other. Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_ni()
5281  * and ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5282  *
5283  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5284  * @sta: the receiver station to which this packet is sent
5285  *	(NULL for multicast packets)
5286  * @info: tx status information
5287  */
5288 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_noskb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5289 					     struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
5290 					     struct ieee80211_tx_info *info)
5291 {
5292 	struct ieee80211_tx_status status = {
5293 		.sta = sta,
5294 		.info = info,
5295 	};
5296 
5297 	ieee80211_tx_status_ext(hw, &status);
5298 }
5299 
5300 /**
5301  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni - transmit status callback (in process context)
5302  *
5303  * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in process context.
5304  *
5305  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5306  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe() may not be mixed
5307  * for a single hardware.
5308  *
5309  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5310  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5311  */
5312 static inline void ieee80211_tx_status_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5313 					  struct sk_buff *skb)
5314 {
5315 	local_bh_disable();
5316 	ieee80211_tx_status_skb(hw, skb);
5317 	local_bh_enable();
5318 }
5319 
5320 /**
5321  * ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe - IRQ-safe transmit status callback
5322  *
5323  * Like ieee80211_tx_status_skb() but can be called in IRQ context
5324  * (internally defers to a tasklet.)
5325  *
5326  * Calls to this function, ieee80211_tx_status_skb() and
5327  * ieee80211_tx_status_ni() may not be mixed for a single hardware.
5328  *
5329  * @hw: the hardware the frame was transmitted by
5330  * @skb: the frame that was transmitted, owned by mac80211 after this call
5331  */
5332 void ieee80211_tx_status_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5333 				 struct sk_buff *skb);
5334 
5335 /**
5336  * ieee80211_report_low_ack - report non-responding station
5337  *
5338  * When operating in AP-mode, call this function to report a non-responding
5339  * connected STA.
5340  *
5341  * @sta: the non-responding connected sta
5342  * @num_packets: number of packets sent to @sta without a response
5343  */
5344 void ieee80211_report_low_ack(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u32 num_packets);
5345 
5346 #define IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM 2
5347 
5348 /**
5349  * struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets - mutable beacon offsets
5350  * @tim_offset: position of TIM element
5351  * @tim_length: size of TIM element
5352  * @cntdwn_counter_offs: array of IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM offsets
5353  *	to countdown counters.  This array can contain zero values which
5354  *	should be ignored.
5355  * @mbssid_off: position of the multiple bssid element
5356  */
5357 struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets {
5358 	u16 tim_offset;
5359 	u16 tim_length;
5360 
5361 	u16 cntdwn_counter_offs[IEEE80211_MAX_CNTDWN_COUNTERS_NUM];
5362 	u16 mbssid_off;
5363 };
5364 
5365 /**
5366  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template - beacon template generation function
5367  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5368  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5369  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5370  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5371  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5372  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5373  *
5374  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5375  * obtain the beacon template.
5376  *
5377  * This function should be used if the beacon frames are generated by the
5378  * device, and then the driver must use the returned beacon as the template
5379  * The driver or the device are responsible to update the DTIM and, when
5380  * applicable, the CSA count.
5381  *
5382  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5383  *
5384  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5385  */
5386 struct sk_buff *
5387 ieee80211_beacon_get_template(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5388 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5389 			      struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5390 			      unsigned int link_id);
5391 
5392 /**
5393  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index - EMA beacon template generation
5394  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5395  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5396  * @offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5397  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5398  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP).
5399  * @ema_index: index of the beacon in the EMA set.
5400  *
5401  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5402  * but returns a beacon template which includes multiple BSSID element at the
5403  * requested index.
5404  *
5405  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL indicates the end of EMA templates.
5406  */
5407 struct sk_buff *
5408 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_index(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5409 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5410 					struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets *offs,
5411 					unsigned int link_id, u8 ema_index);
5412 
5413 /**
5414  * struct ieee80211_ema_beacons - List of EMA beacons
5415  * @cnt: count of EMA beacons.
5416  *
5417  * @bcn: array of EMA beacons.
5418  * @bcn.skb: the skb containing this specific beacon
5419  * @bcn.offs: &struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets pointer to struct that will
5420  *	receive the offsets that may be updated by the driver.
5421  */
5422 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons {
5423 	u8 cnt;
5424 	struct {
5425 		struct sk_buff *skb;
5426 		struct ieee80211_mutable_offsets offs;
5427 	} bcn[];
5428 };
5429 
5430 /**
5431  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list - EMA beacon template generation
5432  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5433  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5434  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for a non-MLD AP)
5435  *
5436  * This function follows the same rules as ieee80211_beacon_get_template()
5437  * but allocates and returns a pointer to list of all beacon templates required
5438  * to cover all profiles in the multiple BSSID set. Each template includes only
5439  * one multiple BSSID element.
5440  *
5441  * Driver must call ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list() to free the memory.
5442  *
5443  * Return: EMA beacon templates of type struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *.
5444  *	%NULL on error.
5445  */
5446 struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *
5447 ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5448 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5449 				       unsigned int link_id);
5450 
5451 /**
5452  * ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list - free an EMA beacon template list
5453  * @ema_beacons: list of EMA beacons of type &struct ieee80211_ema_beacons pointers.
5454  *
5455  * This function will free a list previously acquired by calling
5456  * ieee80211_beacon_get_template_ema_list()
5457  */
5458 void ieee80211_beacon_free_ema_list(struct ieee80211_ema_beacons *ema_beacons);
5459 
5460 /**
5461  * ieee80211_beacon_get_tim - beacon generation function
5462  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5463  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5464  * @tim_offset: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE offset.
5465  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5466  * @tim_length: pointer to variable that will receive the TIM IE length,
5467  *	(including the ID and length bytes!).
5468  *	Set to 0 if invalid (in non-AP modes).
5469  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5470  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5471  *
5472  * If the driver implements beaconing modes, it must use this function to
5473  * obtain the beacon frame.
5474  *
5475  * If the beacon frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5476  * hardware/firmware), the driver uses this function to get each beacon
5477  * frame from mac80211 -- it is responsible for calling this function exactly
5478  * once before the beacon is needed (e.g. based on hardware interrupt).
5479  *
5480  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
5481  *
5482  * Return: The beacon template. %NULL on error.
5483  */
5484 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5485 					 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5486 					 u16 *tim_offset, u16 *tim_length,
5487 					 unsigned int link_id);
5488 
5489 /**
5490  * ieee80211_beacon_get - beacon generation function
5491  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5492  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5493  * @link_id: the link id to which the beacon belongs (or 0 for an AP STA
5494  *	that is not associated with AP MLD).
5495  *
5496  * See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5497  *
5498  * Return: See ieee80211_beacon_get_tim().
5499  */
5500 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_beacon_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5501 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5502 						   unsigned int link_id)
5503 {
5504 	return ieee80211_beacon_get_tim(hw, vif, NULL, NULL, link_id);
5505 }
5506 
5507 /**
5508  * ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn - request mac80211 to decrement the beacon countdown
5509  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5510  *
5511  * The beacon counter should be updated after each beacon transmission.
5512  * This function is called implicitly when
5513  * ieee80211_beacon_get/ieee80211_beacon_get_tim are called, however if the
5514  * beacon frames are generated by the device, the driver should call this
5515  * function after each beacon transmission to sync mac80211's beacon countdown.
5516  *
5517  * Return: new countdown value
5518  */
5519 u8 ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5520 
5521 /**
5522  * ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn - request mac80211 to set beacon countdown
5523  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5524  * @counter: the new value for the counter
5525  *
5526  * The beacon countdown can be changed by the device, this API should be
5527  * used by the device driver to update csa counter in mac80211.
5528  *
5529  * It should never be used together with ieee80211_beacon_update_cntdwn(),
5530  * as it will cause a race condition around the counter value.
5531  */
5532 void ieee80211_beacon_set_cntdwn(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 counter);
5533 
5534 /**
5535  * ieee80211_csa_finish - notify mac80211 about channel switch
5536  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5537  *
5538  * After a channel switch announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5539  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5540  * notify mac80211 that the channel can be changed.
5541  */
5542 void ieee80211_csa_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5543 
5544 /**
5545  * ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete - find out if countdown reached 1
5546  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5547  *
5548  * This function returns whether the countdown reached zero.
5549  */
5550 bool ieee80211_beacon_cntdwn_is_complete(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5551 
5552 /**
5553  * ieee80211_color_change_finish - notify mac80211 about color change
5554  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5555  *
5556  * After a color change announcement was scheduled and the counter in this
5557  * announcement hits 1, this function must be called by the driver to
5558  * notify mac80211 that the color can be changed
5559  */
5560 void ieee80211_color_change_finish(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5561 
5562 /**
5563  * ieee80211_proberesp_get - retrieve a Probe Response template
5564  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5565  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5566  *
5567  * Creates a Probe Response template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5568  * hardware. The destination address should be set by the caller.
5569  *
5570  * Can only be called in AP mode.
5571  *
5572  * Return: The Probe Response template. %NULL on error.
5573  */
5574 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_proberesp_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5575 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5576 
5577 /**
5578  * ieee80211_pspoll_get - retrieve a PS Poll template
5579  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5580  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5581  *
5582  * Creates a PS Poll a template which can, for example, uploaded to
5583  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5584  * AID, BSSID and MAC address is used.
5585  *
5586  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5587  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit.
5588  *
5589  * Return: The PS Poll template. %NULL on error.
5590  */
5591 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_pspoll_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5592 				     struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5593 
5594 /**
5595  * ieee80211_nullfunc_get - retrieve a nullfunc template
5596  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5597  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5598  * @link_id: If the vif is an MLD, get a frame with the link addresses
5599  *	for the given link ID. For a link_id < 0 you get a frame with
5600  *	MLD addresses, however useful that might be.
5601  * @qos_ok: QoS NDP is acceptable to the caller, this should be set
5602  *	if at all possible
5603  *
5604  * Creates a Nullfunc template which can, for example, uploaded to
5605  * hardware. The template must be updated after association so that correct
5606  * BSSID and address is used.
5607  *
5608  * If @qos_ndp is set and the association is to an AP with QoS/WMM, the
5609  * returned packet will be QoS NDP.
5610  *
5611  * Note: Caller (or hardware) is responsible for setting the
5612  * &IEEE80211_FCTL_PM bit as well as Duration and Sequence Control fields.
5613  *
5614  * Return: The nullfunc template. %NULL on error.
5615  */
5616 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_nullfunc_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5617 				       struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5618 				       int link_id, bool qos_ok);
5619 
5620 /**
5621  * ieee80211_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
5622  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5623  * @src_addr: source MAC address
5624  * @ssid: SSID buffer
5625  * @ssid_len: length of SSID
5626  * @tailroom: tailroom to reserve at end of SKB for IEs
5627  *
5628  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
5629  * hardware.
5630  *
5631  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
5632  */
5633 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5634 				       const u8 *src_addr,
5635 				       const u8 *ssid, size_t ssid_len,
5636 				       size_t tailroom);
5637 
5638 /**
5639  * ieee80211_rts_get - RTS frame generation function
5640  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5641  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5642  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5643  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5644  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5645  * @rts: The buffer where to store the RTS frame.
5646  *
5647  * If the RTS frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5648  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5649  * the next RTS frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5650  * for calling this function before and RTS frame is needed.
5651  */
5652 void ieee80211_rts_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5653 		       const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5654 		       const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5655 		       struct ieee80211_rts *rts);
5656 
5657 /**
5658  * ieee80211_rts_duration - Get the duration field for an RTS frame
5659  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5660  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5661  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the RTS.
5662  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5663  *
5664  * If the RTS is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5665  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5666  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5667  *
5668  * Return: The duration.
5669  */
5670 __le16 ieee80211_rts_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5671 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, size_t frame_len,
5672 			      const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5673 
5674 /**
5675  * ieee80211_ctstoself_get - CTS-to-self frame generation function
5676  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5677  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5678  * @frame: pointer to the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5679  * @frame_len: the frame length (in octets).
5680  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5681  * @cts: The buffer where to store the CTS-to-self frame.
5682  *
5683  * If the CTS-to-self frames are generated by the host system (i.e., not in
5684  * hardware/firmware), the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5685  * the next CTS-to-self frame from the 802.11 code. The low-level is responsible
5686  * for calling this function before and CTS-to-self frame is needed.
5687  */
5688 void ieee80211_ctstoself_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5689 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5690 			     const void *frame, size_t frame_len,
5691 			     const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl,
5692 			     struct ieee80211_cts *cts);
5693 
5694 /**
5695  * ieee80211_ctstoself_duration - Get the duration field for a CTS-to-self frame
5696  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5697  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5698  * @frame_len: the length of the frame that is going to be protected by the CTS-to-self.
5699  * @frame_txctl: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
5700  *
5701  * If the CTS-to-self is generated in firmware, but the host system must provide
5702  * the duration field, the low-level driver uses this function to receive
5703  * the duration field value in little-endian byteorder.
5704  *
5705  * Return: The duration.
5706  */
5707 __le16 ieee80211_ctstoself_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5708 				    struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5709 				    size_t frame_len,
5710 				    const struct ieee80211_tx_info *frame_txctl);
5711 
5712 /**
5713  * ieee80211_generic_frame_duration - Calculate the duration field for a frame
5714  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5715  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5716  * @band: the band to calculate the frame duration on
5717  * @frame_len: the length of the frame.
5718  * @rate: the rate at which the frame is going to be transmitted.
5719  *
5720  * Calculate the duration field of some generic frame, given its
5721  * length and transmission rate (in 100kbps).
5722  *
5723  * Return: The duration.
5724  */
5725 __le16 ieee80211_generic_frame_duration(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
5726 					struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5727 					enum nl80211_band band,
5728 					size_t frame_len,
5729 					struct ieee80211_rate *rate);
5730 
5731 /**
5732  * ieee80211_get_buffered_bc - accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames
5733  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5734  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
5735  *
5736  * Function for accessing buffered broadcast and multicast frames. If
5737  * hardware/firmware does not implement buffering of broadcast/multicast
5738  * frames when power saving is used, 802.11 code buffers them in the host
5739  * memory. The low-level driver uses this function to fetch next buffered
5740  * frame. In most cases, this is used when generating beacon frame.
5741  *
5742  * Return: A pointer to the next buffered skb or NULL if no more buffered
5743  * frames are available.
5744  *
5745  * Note: buffered frames are returned only after DTIM beacon frame was
5746  * generated with ieee80211_beacon_get() and the low-level driver must thus
5747  * call ieee80211_beacon_get() first. ieee80211_get_buffered_bc() returns
5748  * NULL if the previous generated beacon was not DTIM, so the low-level driver
5749  * does not need to check for DTIM beacons separately and should be able to
5750  * use common code for all beacons.
5751  */
5752 struct sk_buff *
5753 ieee80211_get_buffered_bc(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
5754 
5755 /**
5756  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv - get a TKIP phase 1 key for IV32
5757  *
5758  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32.
5759  *
5760  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5761  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5762  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5763  */
5764 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5765 			       u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5766 
5767 /**
5768  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key
5769  *
5770  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the IV32 taken
5771  * from the given packet.
5772  *
5773  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5774  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32 value from that will be encrypted
5775  *	with this P1K
5776  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5777  */
5778 static inline void ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5779 					  struct sk_buff *skb, u16 *p1k)
5780 {
5781 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (struct ieee80211_hdr *)skb->data;
5782 	const u8 *data = (u8 *)hdr + ieee80211_hdrlen(hdr->frame_control);
5783 	u32 iv32 = get_unaligned_le32(&data[4]);
5784 
5785 	ieee80211_get_tkip_p1k_iv(keyconf, iv32, p1k);
5786 }
5787 
5788 /**
5789  * ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k - get a TKIP phase 1 key for RX
5790  *
5791  * This function returns the TKIP phase 1 key for the given IV32
5792  * and transmitter address.
5793  *
5794  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5795  * @ta: TA that will be used with the key
5796  * @iv32: IV32 to get the P1K for
5797  * @p1k: a buffer to which the key will be written, as 5 u16 values
5798  */
5799 void ieee80211_get_tkip_rx_p1k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5800 			       const u8 *ta, u32 iv32, u16 *p1k);
5801 
5802 /**
5803  * ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k - get a TKIP phase 2 key
5804  *
5805  * This function computes the TKIP RC4 key for the IV values
5806  * in the packet.
5807  *
5808  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5809  * @skb: the packet to take the IV32/IV16 values from that will be
5810  *	encrypted with this key
5811  * @p2k: a buffer to which the key will be written, 16 bytes
5812  */
5813 void ieee80211_get_tkip_p2k(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5814 			    struct sk_buff *skb, u8 *p2k);
5815 
5816 /**
5817  * ieee80211_tkip_add_iv - write TKIP IV and Ext. IV to pos
5818  *
5819  * @pos: start of crypto header
5820  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5821  * @pn: PN to add
5822  *
5823  * Returns: pointer to the octet following IVs (i.e. beginning of
5824  * the packet payload)
5825  *
5826  * This function writes the tkip IV value to pos (which should
5827  * point to the crypto header)
5828  */
5829 u8 *ieee80211_tkip_add_iv(u8 *pos, struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf, u64 pn);
5830 
5831 /**
5832  * ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq - get key RX sequence counter
5833  *
5834  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5835  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5836  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5837  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5838  * @seq: buffer to receive the sequence data
5839  *
5840  * This function allows a driver to retrieve the current RX IV/PNs
5841  * for the given key. It must not be called if IV checking is done
5842  * by the device and not by mac80211.
5843  *
5844  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5845  * can be done concurrently.
5846  */
5847 void ieee80211_get_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5848 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5849 
5850 /**
5851  * ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq - set key RX sequence counter
5852  *
5853  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5854  * @tid: The TID, or -1 for the management frame value (CCMP/GCMP only);
5855  *	the value on TID 0 is also used for non-QoS frames. For
5856  *	CMAC, only TID 0 is valid.
5857  * @seq: new sequence data
5858  *
5859  * This function allows a driver to set the current RX IV/PNs for the
5860  * given key. This is useful when resuming from WoWLAN sleep and GTK
5861  * rekey may have been done while suspended. It should not be called
5862  * if IV checking is done by the device and not by mac80211.
5863  *
5864  * Note that this function may only be called when no RX processing
5865  * can be done concurrently.
5866  */
5867 void ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf,
5868 			      int tid, struct ieee80211_key_seq *seq);
5869 
5870 /**
5871  * ieee80211_remove_key - remove the given key
5872  * @keyconf: the parameter passed with the set key
5873  *
5874  * Context: Must be called with the wiphy mutex held.
5875  *
5876  * Remove the given key. If the key was uploaded to the hardware at the
5877  * time this function is called, it is not deleted in the hardware but
5878  * instead assumed to have been removed already.
5879  */
5880 void ieee80211_remove_key(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5881 
5882 /**
5883  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add - add a GTK key from rekeying during WoWLAN
5884  * @vif: the virtual interface to add the key on
5885  * @keyconf: new key data
5886  *
5887  * When GTK rekeying was done while the system was suspended, (a) new
5888  * key(s) will be available. These will be needed by mac80211 for proper
5889  * RX processing, so this function allows setting them.
5890  *
5891  * The function returns the newly allocated key structure, which will
5892  * have similar contents to the passed key configuration but point to
5893  * mac80211-owned memory. In case of errors, the function returns an
5894  * ERR_PTR(), use IS_ERR() etc.
5895  *
5896  * Note that this function assumes the key isn't added to hardware
5897  * acceleration, so no TX will be done with the key. Since it's a GTK
5898  * on managed (station) networks, this is true anyway. If the driver
5899  * calls this function from the resume callback and subsequently uses
5900  * the return code 1 to reconfigure the device, this key will be part
5901  * of the reconfiguration.
5902  *
5903  * Note that the driver should also call ieee80211_set_key_rx_seq()
5904  * for the new key for each TID to set up sequence counters properly.
5905  *
5906  * IMPORTANT: If this replaces a key that is present in the hardware,
5907  * then it will attempt to remove it during this call. In many cases
5908  * this isn't what you want, so call ieee80211_remove_key() first for
5909  * the key that's being replaced.
5910  */
5911 struct ieee80211_key_conf *
5912 ieee80211_gtk_rekey_add(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
5913 			struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5914 
5915 /**
5916  * ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify - notify userspace supplicant of rekeying
5917  * @vif: virtual interface the rekeying was done on
5918  * @bssid: The BSSID of the AP, for checking association
5919  * @replay_ctr: the new replay counter after GTK rekeying
5920  * @gfp: allocation flags
5921  */
5922 void ieee80211_gtk_rekey_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *bssid,
5923 				const u8 *replay_ctr, gfp_t gfp);
5924 
5925 /**
5926  * ieee80211_key_mic_failure - increment MIC failure counter for the key
5927  *
5928  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5929  * at the same time.
5930  *
5931  * @keyconf: the key in question
5932  */
5933 void ieee80211_key_mic_failure(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5934 
5935 /**
5936  * ieee80211_key_replay - increment replay counter for the key
5937  *
5938  * Note: this is really only safe if no other RX function is called
5939  * at the same time.
5940  *
5941  * @keyconf: the key in question
5942  */
5943 void ieee80211_key_replay(struct ieee80211_key_conf *keyconf);
5944 
5945 /**
5946  * ieee80211_wake_queue - wake specific queue
5947  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5948  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5949  *
5950  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_wake_queue.
5951  */
5952 void ieee80211_wake_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5953 
5954 /**
5955  * ieee80211_stop_queue - stop specific queue
5956  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5957  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5958  *
5959  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_stop_queue.
5960  */
5961 void ieee80211_stop_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5962 
5963 /**
5964  * ieee80211_queue_stopped - test status of the queue
5965  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5966  * @queue: queue number (counted from zero).
5967  *
5968  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_queue_stopped.
5969  *
5970  * Return: %true if the queue is stopped. %false otherwise.
5971  */
5972 
5973 int ieee80211_queue_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, int queue);
5974 
5975 /**
5976  * ieee80211_stop_queues - stop all queues
5977  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5978  *
5979  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_stop_all_queues.
5980  */
5981 void ieee80211_stop_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5982 
5983 /**
5984  * ieee80211_wake_queues - wake all queues
5985  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
5986  *
5987  * Drivers must use this function instead of netif_tx_wake_all_queues.
5988  */
5989 void ieee80211_wake_queues(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
5990 
5991 /**
5992  * ieee80211_scan_completed - completed hardware scan
5993  *
5994  * When hardware scan offload is used (i.e. the hw_scan() callback is
5995  * assigned) this function needs to be called by the driver to notify
5996  * mac80211 that the scan finished. This function can be called from
5997  * any context, including hardirq context.
5998  *
5999  * @hw: the hardware that finished the scan
6000  * @info: information about the completed scan
6001  */
6002 void ieee80211_scan_completed(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6003 			      struct cfg80211_scan_info *info);
6004 
6005 /**
6006  * ieee80211_sched_scan_results - got results from scheduled scan
6007  *
6008  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function needs to be called by the
6009  * driver whenever there are new scan results available.
6010  *
6011  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6012  */
6013 void ieee80211_sched_scan_results(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6014 
6015 /**
6016  * ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped - inform that the scheduled scan has stopped
6017  *
6018  * When a scheduled scan is running, this function can be called by
6019  * the driver if it needs to stop the scan to perform another task.
6020  * Usual scenarios are drivers that cannot continue the scheduled scan
6021  * while associating, for instance.
6022  *
6023  * @hw: the hardware that is performing scheduled scans
6024  */
6025 void ieee80211_sched_scan_stopped(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6026 
6027 /**
6028  * enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags - interface iteration flags
6029  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL: Iterate over all interfaces that have
6030  *	been added to the driver; However, note that during hardware
6031  *	reconfiguration (after restart_hw) it will iterate over a new
6032  *	interface and over all the existing interfaces even if they
6033  *	haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6034  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL: During resume, iterate over all
6035  *	interfaces, even if they haven't been re-added to the driver yet.
6036  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE: Iterate only active interfaces (netdev is up).
6037  * @IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER: Skip any interfaces where SDATA
6038  *	is not in the driver.  This may fix crashes during firmware recovery
6039  *	for instance.
6040  */
6041 enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags {
6042 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_NORMAL	= 0,
6043 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_RESUME_ALL	= BIT(0),
6044 	IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE	= BIT(1),
6045 	IEEE80211_IFACE_SKIP_SDATA_NOT_IN_DRIVER	= BIT(2),
6046 };
6047 
6048 /**
6049  * ieee80211_iterate_interfaces - iterate interfaces
6050  *
6051  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6052  * hardware and calls the callback for them. This includes active as well as
6053  * inactive interfaces. This function allows the iterator function to sleep.
6054  * Will iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6055  *
6056  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6057  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6058  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6059  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6060  */
6061 void ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6062 				  void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6063 						   struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6064 				  void *data);
6065 
6066 /**
6067  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces - iterate active interfaces
6068  *
6069  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6070  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6071  * This function allows the iterator function to sleep, when the iterator
6072  * function is atomic @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic can
6073  * be used.
6074  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6075  *
6076  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6077  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6078  * @iterator: the iterator function to call
6079  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6080  */
6081 static inline void
6082 ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u32 iter_flags,
6083 				    void (*iterator)(void *data, u8 *mac,
6084 						     struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6085 				    void *data)
6086 {
6087 	ieee80211_iterate_interfaces(hw,
6088 				     iter_flags | IEEE80211_IFACE_ITER_ACTIVE,
6089 				     iterator, data);
6090 }
6091 
6092 /**
6093  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic - iterate active interfaces
6094  *
6095  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6096  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6097  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6098  * if that is not desired, use @ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces instead.
6099  * Does not iterate over a new interface during add_interface().
6100  *
6101  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6102  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6103  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6104  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6105  */
6106 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6107 						u32 iter_flags,
6108 						void (*iterator)(void *data,
6109 						    u8 *mac,
6110 						    struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6111 						void *data);
6112 
6113 /**
6114  * ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx - iterate active interfaces
6115  *
6116  * This function iterates over the interfaces associated with a given
6117  * hardware that are currently active and calls the callback for them.
6118  * This version can only be used while holding the wiphy mutex.
6119  *
6120  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6121  * @iter_flags: iteration flags, see &enum ieee80211_interface_iteration_flags
6122  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6123  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6124  */
6125 void ieee80211_iterate_active_interfaces_mtx(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6126 					     u32 iter_flags,
6127 					     void (*iterator)(void *data,
6128 						u8 *mac,
6129 						struct ieee80211_vif *vif),
6130 					     void *data);
6131 
6132 /**
6133  * ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic - iterate stations
6134  *
6135  * This function iterates over all stations associated with a given
6136  * hardware that are currently uploaded to the driver and calls the callback
6137  * function for them.
6138  * This function requires the iterator callback function to be atomic,
6139  *
6140  * @hw: the hardware struct of which the interfaces should be iterated over
6141  * @iterator: the iterator function to call, cannot sleep
6142  * @data: first argument of the iterator function
6143  */
6144 void ieee80211_iterate_stations_atomic(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6145 				       void (*iterator)(void *data,
6146 						struct ieee80211_sta *sta),
6147 				       void *data);
6148 /**
6149  * ieee80211_queue_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6150  *
6151  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to add work onto the mac80211 workqueue.
6152  * This helper ensures drivers are not queueing work when they should not be.
6153  *
6154  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6155  * @work: the work we want to add onto the mac80211 workqueue
6156  */
6157 void ieee80211_queue_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct work_struct *work);
6158 
6159 /**
6160  * ieee80211_queue_delayed_work - add work onto the mac80211 workqueue
6161  *
6162  * Drivers and mac80211 use this to queue delayed work onto the mac80211
6163  * workqueue.
6164  *
6165  * @hw: the hardware struct for the interface we are adding work for
6166  * @dwork: delayable work to queue onto the mac80211 workqueue
6167  * @delay: number of jiffies to wait before queueing
6168  */
6169 void ieee80211_queue_delayed_work(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6170 				  struct delayed_work *dwork,
6171 				  unsigned long delay);
6172 
6173 /**
6174  * ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer - Refresh a tx agg session timer.
6175  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6176  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6177  *
6178  * This function allows low level driver to refresh tx agg session timer
6179  * to maintain BA session, the session level will still be managed by the
6180  * mac80211.
6181  *
6182  * Note: must be called in an RCU critical section.
6183  */
6184 void ieee80211_refresh_tx_agg_session_timer(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6185 					    u16 tid);
6186 
6187 /**
6188  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session - Start a tx Block Ack session.
6189  * @sta: the station for which to start a BA session
6190  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6191  * @timeout: session timeout value (in TUs)
6192  *
6193  * Return: success if addBA request was sent, failure otherwise
6194  *
6195  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6196  * the need to start aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6197  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6198  */
6199 int ieee80211_start_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid,
6200 				  u16 timeout);
6201 
6202 /**
6203  * ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to aggregate.
6204  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6205  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6206  * @tid: the TID to BA on.
6207  *
6208  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6209  * finished with preparations for the BA session. It can be called
6210  * from any context.
6211  */
6212 void ieee80211_start_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6213 				      u16 tid);
6214 
6215 /**
6216  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session - Stop a Block Ack session.
6217  * @sta: the station whose BA session to stop
6218  * @tid: the TID to stop BA.
6219  *
6220  * Return: negative error if the TID is invalid, or no aggregation active
6221  *
6222  * Although mac80211/low level driver/user space application can estimate
6223  * the need to stop aggregation on a certain RA/TID, the session level
6224  * will be managed by the mac80211.
6225  */
6226 int ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u16 tid);
6227 
6228 /**
6229  * ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe - low level driver ready to stop aggregate.
6230  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6231  * @ra: receiver address of the BA session recipient.
6232  * @tid: the desired TID to BA on.
6233  *
6234  * This function must be called by low level driver once it has
6235  * finished with preparations for the BA session tear down. It
6236  * can be called from any context.
6237  */
6238 void ieee80211_stop_tx_ba_cb_irqsafe(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *ra,
6239 				     u16 tid);
6240 
6241 /**
6242  * ieee80211_find_sta - find a station
6243  *
6244  * @vif: virtual interface to look for station on
6245  * @addr: station's address
6246  *
6247  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6248  *
6249  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6250  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6251  */
6252 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6253 					 const u8 *addr);
6254 
6255 /**
6256  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr - find a station on hardware
6257  *
6258  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6259  * @addr: remote station's address
6260  * @localaddr: local address (vif->sdata->vif.addr). Use NULL for 'any'.
6261  *
6262  * Return: The station, if found. %NULL otherwise.
6263  *
6264  * Note: This function must be called under RCU lock and the
6265  * resulting pointer is only valid under RCU lock as well.
6266  *
6267  * NOTE: You may pass NULL for localaddr, but then you will just get
6268  *      the first STA that matches the remote address 'addr'.
6269  *      We can have multiple STA associated with multiple
6270  *      logical stations (e.g. consider a station connecting to another
6271  *      BSSID on the same AP hardware without disconnecting first).
6272  *      In this case, the result of this method with localaddr NULL
6273  *      is not reliable.
6274  *
6275  * DO NOT USE THIS FUNCTION with localaddr NULL if at all possible.
6276  */
6277 struct ieee80211_sta *ieee80211_find_sta_by_ifaddr(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6278 					       const u8 *addr,
6279 					       const u8 *localaddr);
6280 
6281 /**
6282  * ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs - find STA by link addresses
6283  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6284  * @addr: remote station's link address
6285  * @localaddr: local link address, use %NULL for any (but avoid that)
6286  * @link_id: pointer to obtain the link ID if the STA is found,
6287  *	may be %NULL if the link ID is not needed
6288  *
6289  * Obtain the STA by link address, must use RCU protection.
6290  */
6291 struct ieee80211_sta *
6292 ieee80211_find_sta_by_link_addrs(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6293 				 const u8 *addr,
6294 				 const u8 *localaddr,
6295 				 unsigned int *link_id);
6296 
6297 /**
6298  * ieee80211_sta_block_awake - block station from waking up
6299  * @hw: the hardware
6300  * @pubsta: the station
6301  * @block: whether to block or unblock
6302  *
6303  * Some devices require that all frames that are on the queues
6304  * for a specific station that went to sleep are flushed before
6305  * a poll response or frames after the station woke up can be
6306  * delivered to that it. Note that such frames must be rejected
6307  * by the driver as filtered, with the appropriate status flag.
6308  *
6309  * This function allows implementing this mode in a race-free
6310  * manner.
6311  *
6312  * To do this, a driver must keep track of the number of frames
6313  * still enqueued for a specific station. If this number is not
6314  * zero when the station goes to sleep, the driver must call
6315  * this function to force mac80211 to consider the station to
6316  * be asleep regardless of the station's actual state. Once the
6317  * number of outstanding frames reaches zero, the driver must
6318  * call this function again to unblock the station. That will
6319  * cause mac80211 to be able to send ps-poll responses, and if
6320  * the station queried in the meantime then frames will also
6321  * be sent out as a result of this. Additionally, the driver
6322  * will be notified that the station woke up some time after
6323  * it is unblocked, regardless of whether the station actually
6324  * woke up while blocked or not.
6325  */
6326 void ieee80211_sta_block_awake(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6327 			       struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, bool block);
6328 
6329 /**
6330  * ieee80211_sta_eosp - notify mac80211 about end of SP
6331  * @pubsta: the station
6332  *
6333  * When a device transmits frames in a way that it can't tell
6334  * mac80211 in the TX status about the EOSP, it must clear the
6335  * %IEEE80211_TX_STATUS_EOSP bit and call this function instead.
6336  * This applies for PS-Poll as well as uAPSD.
6337  *
6338  * Note that just like with _tx_status() and _rx() drivers must
6339  * not mix calls to irqsafe/non-irqsafe versions, this function
6340  * must not be mixed with those either. Use the all irqsafe, or
6341  * all non-irqsafe, don't mix!
6342  *
6343  * NB: the _irqsafe version of this function doesn't exist, no
6344  *     driver needs it right now. Don't call this function if
6345  *     you'd need the _irqsafe version, look at the git history
6346  *     and restore the _irqsafe version!
6347  */
6348 void ieee80211_sta_eosp(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6349 
6350 /**
6351  * ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc - ask mac80211 to send NDP with EOSP
6352  * @pubsta: the station
6353  * @tid: the tid of the NDP
6354  *
6355  * Sometimes the device understands that it needs to close
6356  * the Service Period unexpectedly. This can happen when
6357  * sending frames that are filling holes in the BA window.
6358  * In this case, the device can ask mac80211 to send a
6359  * Nullfunc frame with EOSP set. When that happens, the
6360  * driver must have called ieee80211_sta_set_buffered() to
6361  * let mac80211 know that there are no buffered frames any
6362  * more, otherwise mac80211 will get the more_data bit wrong.
6363  * The low level driver must have made sure that the frame
6364  * will be sent despite the station being in power-save.
6365  * Mac80211 won't call allow_buffered_frames().
6366  * Note that calling this function, doesn't exempt the driver
6367  * from closing the EOSP properly, it will still have to call
6368  * ieee80211_sta_eosp when the NDP is sent.
6369  */
6370 void ieee80211_send_eosp_nullfunc(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, int tid);
6371 
6372 /**
6373  * ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates - recalculate aggregate data after a change
6374  * @pubsta: the station
6375  *
6376  * Call this function after changing a per-link aggregate data as referenced in
6377  * &struct ieee80211_sta_aggregates by accessing the agg field of
6378  * &struct ieee80211_link_sta.
6379  *
6380  * With non MLO the data in deflink will be referenced directly. In that case
6381  * there is no need to call this function.
6382  */
6383 void ieee80211_sta_recalc_aggregates(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta);
6384 
6385 /**
6386  * ieee80211_sta_register_airtime - register airtime usage for a sta/tid
6387  *
6388  * Register airtime usage for a given sta on a given tid. The driver must call
6389  * this function to notify mac80211 that a station used a certain amount of
6390  * airtime. This information will be used by the TXQ scheduler to schedule
6391  * stations in a way that ensures airtime fairness.
6392  *
6393  * The reported airtime should as a minimum include all time that is spent
6394  * transmitting to the remote station, including overhead and padding, but not
6395  * including time spent waiting for a TXOP. If the time is not reported by the
6396  * hardware it can in some cases be calculated from the rate and known frame
6397  * composition. When possible, the time should include any failed transmission
6398  * attempts.
6399  *
6400  * The driver can either call this function synchronously for every packet or
6401  * aggregate, or asynchronously as airtime usage information becomes available.
6402  * TX and RX airtime can be reported together, or separately by setting one of
6403  * them to 0.
6404  *
6405  * @pubsta: the station
6406  * @tid: the TID to register airtime for
6407  * @tx_airtime: airtime used during TX (in usec)
6408  * @rx_airtime: airtime used during RX (in usec)
6409  */
6410 void ieee80211_sta_register_airtime(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6411 				    u32 tx_airtime, u32 rx_airtime);
6412 
6413 /**
6414  * ieee80211_txq_airtime_check - check if a txq can send frame to device
6415  *
6416  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6417  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
6418  *
6419  * Return true if the AQL's airtime limit has not been reached and the txq can
6420  * continue to send more packets to the device. Otherwise return false.
6421  */
6422 bool
6423 ieee80211_txq_airtime_check(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
6424 
6425 /**
6426  * ieee80211_iter_keys - iterate keys programmed into the device
6427  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6428  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6429  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6430  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6431  *
6432  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; can sleep.
6433  *
6434  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6435  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6436  * the device. This is intended for use in WoWLAN if the device
6437  * needs reprogramming of the keys during suspend.
6438  *
6439  * The order in which the keys are iterated matches the order
6440  * in which they were originally installed and handed to the
6441  * set_key callback.
6442  */
6443 void ieee80211_iter_keys(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6444 			 struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6445 			 void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6446 				      struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6447 				      struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6448 				      struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6449 				      void *data),
6450 			 void *iter_data);
6451 
6452 /**
6453  * ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu - iterate keys programmed into the device
6454  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6455  * @vif: virtual interface to iterate, may be %NULL for all
6456  * @iter: iterator function that will be called for each key
6457  * @iter_data: custom data to pass to the iterator function
6458  *
6459  * This function can be used to iterate all the keys known to
6460  * mac80211, even those that weren't previously programmed into
6461  * the device. Note that due to locking reasons, keys of station
6462  * in removal process will be skipped.
6463  *
6464  * This function requires being called in an RCU critical section,
6465  * and thus iter must be atomic.
6466  */
6467 void ieee80211_iter_keys_rcu(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6468 			     struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6469 			     void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6470 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6471 					  struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6472 					  struct ieee80211_key_conf *key,
6473 					  void *data),
6474 			     void *iter_data);
6475 
6476 /**
6477  * ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic - iterate channel contexts
6478  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6479  * @iter: iterator function
6480  * @iter_data: data passed to iterator function
6481  *
6482  * Iterate all active channel contexts. This function is atomic and
6483  * doesn't acquire any locks internally that might be held in other
6484  * places while calling into the driver.
6485  *
6486  * The iterator will not find a context that's being added (during
6487  * the driver callback to add it) but will find it while it's being
6488  * removed.
6489  *
6490  * Note that during hardware restart, all contexts that existed
6491  * before the restart are considered already present so will be
6492  * found while iterating, whether they've been re-added already
6493  * or not.
6494  */
6495 void ieee80211_iter_chan_contexts_atomic(
6496 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6497 	void (*iter)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6498 		     struct ieee80211_chanctx_conf *chanctx_conf,
6499 		     void *data),
6500 	void *iter_data);
6501 
6502 /**
6503  * ieee80211_ap_probereq_get - retrieve a Probe Request template
6504  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
6505  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6506  *
6507  * Creates a Probe Request template which can, for example, be uploaded to
6508  * hardware. The template is filled with bssid, ssid and supported rate
6509  * information. This function must only be called from within the
6510  * .bss_info_changed callback function and only in managed mode. The function
6511  * is only useful when the interface is associated, otherwise it will return
6512  * %NULL.
6513  *
6514  * Return: The Probe Request template. %NULL on error.
6515  */
6516 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_ap_probereq_get(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6517 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6518 
6519 /**
6520  * ieee80211_beacon_loss - inform hardware does not receive beacons
6521  *
6522  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6523  *
6524  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER and
6525  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS is set, the driver needs to inform whenever the
6526  * hardware is not receiving beacons with this function.
6527  */
6528 void ieee80211_beacon_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6529 
6530 /**
6531  * ieee80211_connection_loss - inform hardware has lost connection to the AP
6532  *
6533  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6534  *
6535  * When beacon filtering is enabled with %IEEE80211_VIF_BEACON_FILTER, and
6536  * %IEEE80211_CONF_PS and %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR are set, the driver
6537  * needs to inform if the connection to the AP has been lost.
6538  * The function may also be called if the connection needs to be terminated
6539  * for some other reason, even if %IEEE80211_HW_CONNECTION_MONITOR isn't set.
6540  *
6541  * This function will cause immediate change to disassociated state,
6542  * without connection recovery attempts.
6543  */
6544 void ieee80211_connection_loss(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6545 
6546 /**
6547  * ieee80211_disconnect - request disconnection
6548  *
6549  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6550  * @reconnect: immediate reconnect is desired
6551  *
6552  * Request disconnection from the current network and, if enabled, send a
6553  * hint to the higher layers that immediate reconnect is desired.
6554  */
6555 void ieee80211_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool reconnect);
6556 
6557 /**
6558  * ieee80211_resume_disconnect - disconnect from AP after resume
6559  *
6560  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6561  *
6562  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after resume.
6563  * Drivers can use this after WoWLAN if they know that the
6564  * connection cannot be kept up, for example because keys were
6565  * used while the device was asleep but the replay counters or
6566  * similar cannot be retrieved from the device during resume.
6567  *
6568  * Note that due to implementation issues, if the driver uses
6569  * the reconfiguration functionality during resume the interface
6570  * will still be added as associated first during resume and then
6571  * disconnect normally later.
6572  *
6573  * This function can only be called from the resume callback and
6574  * the driver must not be holding any of its own locks while it
6575  * calls this function, or at least not any locks it needs in the
6576  * key configuration paths (if it supports HW crypto).
6577  */
6578 void ieee80211_resume_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6579 
6580 /**
6581  * ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect - disconnect from AP after
6582  * hardware restart
6583  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6584  *
6585  * Instructs mac80211 to disconnect from the AP after
6586  * hardware restart.
6587  */
6588 void ieee80211_hw_restart_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
6589 
6590 /**
6591  * ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify - inform a configured connection quality monitoring
6592  *	rssi threshold triggered
6593  *
6594  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6595  * @rssi_event: the RSSI trigger event type
6596  * @rssi_level: new RSSI level value or 0 if not available
6597  * @gfp: context flags
6598  *
6599  * When the %IEEE80211_VIF_SUPPORTS_CQM_RSSI is set, and a connection quality
6600  * monitoring is configured with an rssi threshold, the driver will inform
6601  * whenever the rssi level reaches the threshold.
6602  */
6603 void ieee80211_cqm_rssi_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6604 			       enum nl80211_cqm_rssi_threshold_event rssi_event,
6605 			       s32 rssi_level,
6606 			       gfp_t gfp);
6607 
6608 /**
6609  * ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify - inform CQM of beacon loss
6610  *
6611  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6612  * @gfp: context flags
6613  */
6614 void ieee80211_cqm_beacon_loss_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, gfp_t gfp);
6615 
6616 /**
6617  * ieee80211_radar_detected - inform that a radar was detected
6618  *
6619  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6620  */
6621 void ieee80211_radar_detected(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6622 
6623 /**
6624  * ieee80211_chswitch_done - Complete channel switch process
6625  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6626  * @success: make the channel switch successful or not
6627  * @link_id: the link_id on which the switch was done. Ignored if success is
6628  *	false.
6629  *
6630  * Complete the channel switch post-process: set the new operational channel
6631  * and wake up the suspended queues.
6632  */
6633 void ieee80211_chswitch_done(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool success,
6634 			     unsigned int link_id);
6635 
6636 /**
6637  * ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect - disconnect due to channel switch error
6638  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6639  * @block_tx: if %true, do not send deauth frame.
6640  *
6641  * Instruct mac80211 to disconnect due to a channel switch error. The channel
6642  * switch can request to block the tx and so, we need to make sure we do not send
6643  * a deauth frame in this case.
6644  */
6645 void ieee80211_channel_switch_disconnect(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6646 					 bool block_tx);
6647 
6648 /**
6649  * ieee80211_request_smps - request SM PS transition
6650  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6651  * @link_id: link ID for MLO, or 0
6652  * @smps_mode: new SM PS mode
6653  *
6654  * This allows the driver to request an SM PS transition in managed
6655  * mode. This is useful when the driver has more information than
6656  * the stack about possible interference, for example by bluetooth.
6657  */
6658 void ieee80211_request_smps(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
6659 			    enum ieee80211_smps_mode smps_mode);
6660 
6661 /**
6662  * ieee80211_ready_on_channel - notification of remain-on-channel start
6663  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6664  */
6665 void ieee80211_ready_on_channel(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6666 
6667 /**
6668  * ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired - remain_on_channel duration expired
6669  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6670  */
6671 void ieee80211_remain_on_channel_expired(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6672 
6673 /**
6674  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session - callback to stop existing BA sessions
6675  *
6676  * in order not to harm the system performance and user experience, the device
6677  * may request not to allow any rx ba session and tear down existing rx ba
6678  * sessions based on system constraints such as periodic BT activity that needs
6679  * to limit wlan activity (eg.sco or a2dp)."
6680  * in such cases, the intention is to limit the duration of the rx ppdu and
6681  * therefore prevent the peer device to use a-mpdu aggregation.
6682  *
6683  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6684  * @ba_rx_bitmap: Bit map of open rx ba per tid
6685  * @addr: & to bssid mac address
6686  */
6687 void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 ba_rx_bitmap,
6688 				  const u8 *addr);
6689 
6690 /**
6691  * ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames - move RX BA window and mark filtered
6692  * @pubsta: station struct
6693  * @tid: the session's TID
6694  * @ssn: starting sequence number of the bitmap, all frames before this are
6695  *	assumed to be out of the window after the call
6696  * @filtered: bitmap of filtered frames, BIT(0) is the @ssn entry etc.
6697  * @received_mpdus: number of received mpdus in firmware
6698  *
6699  * This function moves the BA window and releases all frames before @ssn, and
6700  * marks frames marked in the bitmap as having been filtered. Afterwards, it
6701  * checks if any frames in the window starting from @ssn can now be released
6702  * (in case they were only waiting for frames that were filtered.)
6703  * (Only work correctly if @max_rx_aggregation_subframes <= 64 frames)
6704  */
6705 void ieee80211_mark_rx_ba_filtered_frames(struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta, u8 tid,
6706 					  u16 ssn, u64 filtered,
6707 					  u16 received_mpdus);
6708 
6709 /**
6710  * ieee80211_send_bar - send a BlockAckReq frame
6711  *
6712  * can be used to flush pending frames from the peer's aggregation reorder
6713  * buffer.
6714  *
6715  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
6716  * @ra: the peer's destination address
6717  * @tid: the TID of the aggregation session
6718  * @ssn: the new starting sequence number for the receiver
6719  */
6720 void ieee80211_send_bar(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u8 *ra, u16 tid, u16 ssn);
6721 
6722 /**
6723  * ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl - helper to queue an RX BA work
6724  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6725  * @addr: station mac address
6726  * @tid: the rx tid
6727  */
6728 void ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *addr,
6729 				 unsigned int tid);
6730 
6731 /**
6732  * ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl - start a Rx BA session
6733  *
6734  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6735  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6736  * reordering.
6737  *
6738  * Create structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6739  * when they complete AddBa negotiation.
6740  *
6741  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6742  * @addr: station mac address
6743  * @tid: the rx tid
6744  */
6745 static inline void ieee80211_start_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6746 						      const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6747 {
6748 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6749 		return;
6750 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid);
6751 }
6752 
6753 /**
6754  * ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl - stop a Rx BA session
6755  *
6756  * Some device drivers may offload part of the Rx aggregation flow including
6757  * AddBa/DelBa negotiation but may otherwise be incapable of full Rx
6758  * reordering.
6759  *
6760  * Destroy structures responsible for reordering so device drivers may call here
6761  * when they complete DelBa negotiation.
6762  *
6763  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6764  * @addr: station mac address
6765  * @tid: the rx tid
6766  */
6767 static inline void ieee80211_stop_rx_ba_session_offl(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6768 						     const u8 *addr, u16 tid)
6769 {
6770 	if (WARN_ON(tid >= IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS))
6771 		return;
6772 	ieee80211_manage_rx_ba_offl(vif, addr, tid + IEEE80211_NUM_TIDS);
6773 }
6774 
6775 /**
6776  * ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired - stop a Rx BA session due to timeout
6777  *
6778  * Some device drivers do not offload AddBa/DelBa negotiation, but handle rx
6779  * buffer reording internally, and therefore also handle the session timer.
6780  *
6781  * Trigger the timeout flow, which sends a DelBa.
6782  *
6783  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback
6784  * @addr: station mac address
6785  * @tid: the rx tid
6786  */
6787 void ieee80211_rx_ba_timer_expired(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
6788 				   const u8 *addr, unsigned int tid);
6789 
6790 /* Rate control API */
6791 
6792 /**
6793  * struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control - rate control information for/from RC algo
6794  *
6795  * @hw: The hardware the algorithm is invoked for.
6796  * @sband: The band this frame is being transmitted on.
6797  * @bss_conf: the current BSS configuration
6798  * @skb: the skb that will be transmitted, the control information in it needs
6799  *	to be filled in
6800  * @reported_rate: The rate control algorithm can fill this in to indicate
6801  *	which rate should be reported to userspace as the current rate and
6802  *	used for rate calculations in the mesh network.
6803  * @rts: whether RTS will be used for this frame because it is longer than the
6804  *	RTS threshold
6805  * @short_preamble: whether mac80211 will request short-preamble transmission
6806  *	if the selected rate supports it
6807  * @rate_idx_mask: user-requested (legacy) rate mask
6808  * @rate_idx_mcs_mask: user-requested MCS rate mask (NULL if not in use)
6809  * @bss: whether this frame is sent out in AP or IBSS mode
6810  */
6811 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control {
6812 	struct ieee80211_hw *hw;
6813 	struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband;
6814 	struct ieee80211_bss_conf *bss_conf;
6815 	struct sk_buff *skb;
6816 	struct ieee80211_tx_rate reported_rate;
6817 	bool rts, short_preamble;
6818 	u32 rate_idx_mask;
6819 	u8 *rate_idx_mcs_mask;
6820 	bool bss;
6821 };
6822 
6823 /**
6824  * enum rate_control_capabilities - rate control capabilities
6825  */
6826 enum rate_control_capabilities {
6827 	/**
6828 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW:
6829 	 * Support for extended NSS BW support (dot11VHTExtendedNSSCapable)
6830 	 * Note that this is only looked at if the minimum number of chains
6831 	 * that the AP uses is < the number of TX chains the hardware has,
6832 	 * otherwise the NSS difference doesn't bother us.
6833 	 */
6834 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_VHT_EXT_NSS_BW = BIT(0),
6835 	/**
6836 	 * @RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER:
6837 	 * mac80211 should start A-MPDU sessions on tx
6838 	 */
6839 	RATE_CTRL_CAPA_AMPDU_TRIGGER = BIT(1),
6840 };
6841 
6842 struct rate_control_ops {
6843 	unsigned long capa;
6844 	const char *name;
6845 	void *(*alloc)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw);
6846 	void (*add_debugfs)(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, void *priv,
6847 			    struct dentry *debugfsdir);
6848 	void (*free)(void *priv);
6849 
6850 	void *(*alloc_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, gfp_t gfp);
6851 	void (*rate_init)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6852 			  struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6853 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta);
6854 	void (*rate_update)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6855 			    struct cfg80211_chan_def *chandef,
6856 			    struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6857 			    u32 changed);
6858 	void (*free_sta)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6859 			 void *priv_sta);
6860 
6861 	void (*tx_status_ext)(void *priv,
6862 			      struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6863 			      void *priv_sta, struct ieee80211_tx_status *st);
6864 	void (*tx_status)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6865 			  struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6866 			  struct sk_buff *skb);
6867 	void (*get_rate)(void *priv, struct ieee80211_sta *sta, void *priv_sta,
6868 			 struct ieee80211_tx_rate_control *txrc);
6869 
6870 	void (*add_sta_debugfs)(void *priv, void *priv_sta,
6871 				struct dentry *dir);
6872 
6873 	u32 (*get_expected_throughput)(void *priv_sta);
6874 };
6875 
6876 static inline int rate_supported(struct ieee80211_sta *sta,
6877 				 enum nl80211_band band,
6878 				 int index)
6879 {
6880 	return (sta == NULL || sta->deflink.supp_rates[band] & BIT(index));
6881 }
6882 
6883 static inline s8
6884 rate_lowest_index(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6885 		  struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6886 {
6887 	int i;
6888 
6889 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6890 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6891 			return i;
6892 
6893 	/* warn when we cannot find a rate. */
6894 	WARN_ON_ONCE(1);
6895 
6896 	/* and return 0 (the lowest index) */
6897 	return 0;
6898 }
6899 
6900 static inline
6901 bool rate_usable_index_exists(struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6902 			      struct ieee80211_sta *sta)
6903 {
6904 	unsigned int i;
6905 
6906 	for (i = 0; i < sband->n_bitrates; i++)
6907 		if (rate_supported(sta, sband->band, i))
6908 			return true;
6909 	return false;
6910 }
6911 
6912 /**
6913  * rate_control_set_rates - pass the sta rate selection to mac80211/driver
6914  *
6915  * When not doing a rate control probe to test rates, rate control should pass
6916  * its rate selection to mac80211. If the driver supports receiving a station
6917  * rate table, it will use it to ensure that frames are always sent based on
6918  * the most recent rate control module decision.
6919  *
6920  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
6921  * @pubsta: &struct ieee80211_sta pointer to the target destination.
6922  * @rates: new tx rate set to be used for this station.
6923  */
6924 int rate_control_set_rates(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
6925 			   struct ieee80211_sta *pubsta,
6926 			   struct ieee80211_sta_rates *rates);
6927 
6928 int ieee80211_rate_control_register(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6929 void ieee80211_rate_control_unregister(const struct rate_control_ops *ops);
6930 
6931 static inline bool
6932 conf_is_ht20(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6933 {
6934 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20;
6935 }
6936 
6937 static inline bool
6938 conf_is_ht40_minus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6939 {
6940 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6941 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 < conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6942 }
6943 
6944 static inline bool
6945 conf_is_ht40_plus(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6946 {
6947 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40 &&
6948 	       conf->chandef.center_freq1 > conf->chandef.chan->center_freq;
6949 }
6950 
6951 static inline bool
6952 conf_is_ht40(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6953 {
6954 	return conf->chandef.width == NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_40;
6955 }
6956 
6957 static inline bool
6958 conf_is_ht(struct ieee80211_conf *conf)
6959 {
6960 	return (conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_5) &&
6961 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_10) &&
6962 		(conf->chandef.width != NL80211_CHAN_WIDTH_20_NOHT);
6963 }
6964 
6965 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6966 ieee80211_iftype_p2p(enum nl80211_iftype type, bool p2p)
6967 {
6968 	if (p2p) {
6969 		switch (type) {
6970 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_STATION:
6971 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_CLIENT;
6972 		case NL80211_IFTYPE_AP:
6973 			return NL80211_IFTYPE_P2P_GO;
6974 		default:
6975 			break;
6976 		}
6977 	}
6978 	return type;
6979 }
6980 
6981 static inline enum nl80211_iftype
6982 ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6983 {
6984 	return ieee80211_iftype_p2p(vif->type, vif->p2p);
6985 }
6986 
6987 /**
6988  * ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif - return HE capabilities for sband/vif
6989  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
6990  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
6991  *
6992  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap, or %NULL is none found
6993  */
6994 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_he_cap *
6995 ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
6996 				struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
6997 {
6998 	return ieee80211_get_he_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
6999 }
7000 
7001 /**
7002  * ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif - return HE 6 GHz capabilities
7003  * @sband: the sband to search for the STA on
7004  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7005  *
7006  * Return: the 6GHz capabilities
7007  */
7008 static inline __le16
7009 ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7010 			       struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7011 {
7012 	return ieee80211_get_he_6ghz_capa(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7013 }
7014 
7015 /**
7016  * ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif - return ETH capabilities for sband/vif
7017  * @sband: the sband to search for the iftype on
7018  * @vif: the vif to get the iftype from
7019  *
7020  * Return: pointer to the struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap, or %NULL is none found
7021  */
7022 static inline const struct ieee80211_sta_eht_cap *
7023 ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap_vif(const struct ieee80211_supported_band *sband,
7024 				 struct ieee80211_vif *vif)
7025 {
7026 	return ieee80211_get_eht_iftype_cap(sband, ieee80211_vif_type_p2p(vif));
7027 }
7028 
7029 /**
7030  * ieee80211_update_mu_groups - set the VHT MU-MIMO groud data
7031  *
7032  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7033  * @link_id: the link ID for MLO, otherwise 0
7034  * @membership: 64 bits array - a bit is set if station is member of the group
7035  * @position: 2 bits per group id indicating the position in the group
7036  *
7037  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid and the position and
7038  * membership data is of the correct size and are in the same byte order as the
7039  * matching GroupId management frame.
7040  * Calls to this function need to be serialized with RX path.
7041  */
7042 void ieee80211_update_mu_groups(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, unsigned int link_id,
7043 				const u8 *membership, const u8 *position);
7044 
7045 void ieee80211_enable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7046 				   int rssi_min_thold,
7047 				   int rssi_max_thold);
7048 
7049 void ieee80211_disable_rssi_reports(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7050 
7051 /**
7052  * ieee80211_ave_rssi - report the average RSSI for the specified interface
7053  *
7054  * @vif: the specified virtual interface
7055  *
7056  * Note: This function assumes that the given vif is valid.
7057  *
7058  * Return: The average RSSI value for the requested interface, or 0 if not
7059  * applicable.
7060  */
7061 int ieee80211_ave_rssi(struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7062 
7063 /**
7064  * ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup - report WoWLAN wakeup
7065  * @vif: virtual interface
7066  * @wakeup: wakeup reason(s)
7067  * @gfp: allocation flags
7068  *
7069  * See cfg80211_report_wowlan_wakeup().
7070  */
7071 void ieee80211_report_wowlan_wakeup(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7072 				    struct cfg80211_wowlan_wakeup *wakeup,
7073 				    gfp_t gfp);
7074 
7075 /**
7076  * ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb - prepare an 802.11 skb for transmission
7077  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7078  * @vif: virtual interface
7079  * @skb: frame to be sent from within the driver
7080  * @band: the band to transmit on
7081  * @sta: optional pointer to get the station to send the frame to
7082  *
7083  * Note: must be called under RCU lock
7084  */
7085 bool ieee80211_tx_prepare_skb(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7086 			      struct ieee80211_vif *vif, struct sk_buff *skb,
7087 			      int band, struct ieee80211_sta **sta);
7088 
7089 /**
7090  * ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap - Sanity-check and parse the radiotap header
7091  *				 of injected frames.
7092  *
7093  * To accurately parse and take into account rate and retransmission fields,
7094  * you must initialize the chandef field in the ieee80211_tx_info structure
7095  * of the skb before calling this function.
7096  *
7097  * @skb: packet injected by userspace
7098  * @dev: the &struct device of this 802.11 device
7099  */
7100 bool ieee80211_parse_tx_radiotap(struct sk_buff *skb,
7101 				 struct net_device *dev);
7102 
7103 /**
7104  * struct ieee80211_noa_data - holds temporary data for tracking P2P NoA state
7105  *
7106  * @next_tsf: TSF timestamp of the next absent state change
7107  * @has_next_tsf: next absent state change event pending
7108  *
7109  * @absent: descriptor bitmask, set if GO is currently absent
7110  *
7111  * private:
7112  *
7113  * @count: count fields from the NoA descriptors
7114  * @desc: adjusted data from the NoA
7115  */
7116 struct ieee80211_noa_data {
7117 	u32 next_tsf;
7118 	bool has_next_tsf;
7119 
7120 	u8 absent;
7121 
7122 	u8 count[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7123 	struct {
7124 		u32 start;
7125 		u32 duration;
7126 		u32 interval;
7127 	} desc[IEEE80211_P2P_NOA_DESC_MAX];
7128 };
7129 
7130 /**
7131  * ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa - initialize NoA tracking data from P2P IE
7132  *
7133  * @attr: P2P NoA IE
7134  * @data: NoA tracking data
7135  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7136  *
7137  * Return: number of successfully parsed descriptors
7138  */
7139 int ieee80211_parse_p2p_noa(const struct ieee80211_p2p_noa_attr *attr,
7140 			    struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7141 
7142 /**
7143  * ieee80211_update_p2p_noa - get next pending P2P GO absent state change
7144  *
7145  * @data: NoA tracking data
7146  * @tsf: current TSF timestamp
7147  */
7148 void ieee80211_update_p2p_noa(struct ieee80211_noa_data *data, u32 tsf);
7149 
7150 /**
7151  * ieee80211_tdls_oper_request - request userspace to perform a TDLS operation
7152  * @vif: virtual interface
7153  * @peer: the peer's destination address
7154  * @oper: the requested TDLS operation
7155  * @reason_code: reason code for the operation, valid for TDLS teardown
7156  * @gfp: allocation flags
7157  *
7158  * See cfg80211_tdls_oper_request().
7159  */
7160 void ieee80211_tdls_oper_request(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, const u8 *peer,
7161 				 enum nl80211_tdls_operation oper,
7162 				 u16 reason_code, gfp_t gfp);
7163 
7164 /**
7165  * ieee80211_reserve_tid - request to reserve a specific TID
7166  *
7167  * There is sometimes a need (such as in TDLS) for blocking the driver from
7168  * using a specific TID so that the FW can use it for certain operations such
7169  * as sending PTI requests. To make sure that the driver doesn't use that TID,
7170  * this function must be called as it flushes out packets on this TID and marks
7171  * it as blocked, so that any transmit for the station on this TID will be
7172  * redirected to the alternative TID in the same AC.
7173  *
7174  * Note that this function blocks and may call back into the driver, so it
7175  * should be called without driver locks held. Also note this function should
7176  * only be called from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7177  *
7178  * @sta: the station to reserve the TID for
7179  * @tid: the TID to reserve
7180  *
7181  * Returns: 0 on success, else on failure
7182  */
7183 int ieee80211_reserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7184 
7185 /**
7186  * ieee80211_unreserve_tid - request to unreserve a specific TID
7187  *
7188  * Once there is no longer any need for reserving a certain TID, this function
7189  * should be called, and no longer will packets have their TID modified for
7190  * preventing use of this TID in the driver.
7191  *
7192  * Note that this function blocks and acquires a lock, so it should be called
7193  * without driver locks held. Also note this function should only be called
7194  * from the driver's @sta_state callback.
7195  *
7196  * @sta: the station
7197  * @tid: the TID to unreserve
7198  */
7199 void ieee80211_unreserve_tid(struct ieee80211_sta *sta, u8 tid);
7200 
7201 /**
7202  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7203  *
7204  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7205  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7206  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7207  *
7208  * Returns the skb if successful, %NULL if no frame was available.
7209  *
7210  * Note that this must be called in an rcu_read_lock() critical section,
7211  * which can only be released after the SKB was handled. Some pointers in
7212  * skb->cb, e.g. the key pointer, are protected by RCU and thus the
7213  * critical section must persist not just for the duration of this call
7214  * but for the duration of the frame handling.
7215  * However, also note that while in the wake_tx_queue() method,
7216  * rcu_read_lock() is already held.
7217  *
7218  * softirqs must also be disabled when this function is called.
7219  * In process context, use ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni() instead.
7220  */
7221 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7222 				     struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7223 
7224 /**
7225  * ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni - dequeue a packet from a software tx queue
7226  * (in process context)
7227  *
7228  * Like ieee80211_tx_dequeue() but can be called in process context
7229  * (internally disables bottom halves).
7230  *
7231  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7232  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface, or from
7233  *	ieee80211_next_txq()
7234  */
7235 static inline struct sk_buff *ieee80211_tx_dequeue_ni(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7236 						      struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7237 {
7238 	struct sk_buff *skb;
7239 
7240 	local_bh_disable();
7241 	skb = ieee80211_tx_dequeue(hw, txq);
7242 	local_bh_enable();
7243 
7244 	return skb;
7245 }
7246 
7247 /**
7248  * ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue - mac80211 handler for wake_tx_queue callback
7249  *
7250  * @hw: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7251  * @txq: pointer as obtained from wake_tx_queue() callback().
7252  *
7253  * Drivers can use this function for the mandatory mac80211 wake_tx_queue
7254  * callback in struct ieee80211_ops. They should not call this function.
7255  */
7256 void ieee80211_handle_wake_tx_queue(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7257 				    struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7258 
7259 /**
7260  * ieee80211_next_txq - get next tx queue to pull packets from
7261  *
7262  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7263  * @ac: AC number to return packets from.
7264  *
7265  * Returns the next txq if successful, %NULL if no queue is eligible. If a txq
7266  * is returned, it should be returned with ieee80211_return_txq() after the
7267  * driver has finished scheduling it.
7268  */
7269 struct ieee80211_txq *ieee80211_next_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7270 
7271 /**
7272  * ieee80211_txq_schedule_start - start new scheduling round for TXQs
7273  *
7274  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7275  * @ac: AC number to acquire locks for
7276  *
7277  * Should be called before ieee80211_next_txq() or ieee80211_return_txq().
7278  * The driver must not call multiple TXQ scheduling rounds concurrently.
7279  */
7280 void ieee80211_txq_schedule_start(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac);
7281 
7282 /* (deprecated) */
7283 static inline void ieee80211_txq_schedule_end(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, u8 ac)
7284 {
7285 }
7286 
7287 void __ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7288 			      struct ieee80211_txq *txq, bool force);
7289 
7290 /**
7291  * ieee80211_schedule_txq - schedule a TXQ for transmission
7292  *
7293  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7294  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7295  *
7296  * Schedules a TXQ for transmission if it is not already scheduled,
7297  * even if mac80211 does not have any packets buffered.
7298  *
7299  * The driver may call this function if it has buffered packets for
7300  * this TXQ internally.
7301  */
7302 static inline void
7303 ieee80211_schedule_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq)
7304 {
7305 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, true);
7306 }
7307 
7308 /**
7309  * ieee80211_return_txq - return a TXQ previously acquired by ieee80211_next_txq()
7310  *
7311  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7312  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7313  * @force: schedule txq even if mac80211 does not have any buffered packets.
7314  *
7315  * The driver may set force=true if it has buffered packets for this TXQ
7316  * internally.
7317  */
7318 static inline void
7319 ieee80211_return_txq(struct ieee80211_hw *hw, struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7320 		     bool force)
7321 {
7322 	__ieee80211_schedule_txq(hw, txq, force);
7323 }
7324 
7325 /**
7326  * ieee80211_txq_may_transmit - check whether TXQ is allowed to transmit
7327  *
7328  * This function is used to check whether given txq is allowed to transmit by
7329  * the airtime scheduler, and can be used by drivers to access the airtime
7330  * fairness accounting without using the scheduling order enforced by
7331  * next_txq().
7332  *
7333  * Returns %true if the airtime scheduler thinks the TXQ should be allowed to
7334  * transmit, and %false if it should be throttled. This function can also have
7335  * the side effect of rotating the TXQ in the scheduler rotation, which will
7336  * eventually bring the deficit to positive and allow the station to transmit
7337  * again.
7338  *
7339  * The API ieee80211_txq_may_transmit() also ensures that TXQ list will be
7340  * aligned against driver's own round-robin scheduler list. i.e it rotates
7341  * the TXQ list till it makes the requested node becomes the first entry
7342  * in TXQ list. Thus both the TXQ list and driver's list are in sync. If this
7343  * function returns %true, the driver is expected to schedule packets
7344  * for transmission, and then return the TXQ through ieee80211_return_txq().
7345  *
7346  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7347  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7348  */
7349 bool ieee80211_txq_may_transmit(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7350 				struct ieee80211_txq *txq);
7351 
7352 /**
7353  * ieee80211_txq_get_depth - get pending frame/byte count of given txq
7354  *
7355  * The values are not guaranteed to be coherent with regard to each other, i.e.
7356  * txq state can change half-way of this function and the caller may end up
7357  * with "new" frame_cnt and "old" byte_cnt or vice-versa.
7358  *
7359  * @txq: pointer obtained from station or virtual interface
7360  * @frame_cnt: pointer to store frame count
7361  * @byte_cnt: pointer to store byte count
7362  */
7363 void ieee80211_txq_get_depth(struct ieee80211_txq *txq,
7364 			     unsigned long *frame_cnt,
7365 			     unsigned long *byte_cnt);
7366 
7367 /**
7368  * ieee80211_nan_func_terminated - notify about NAN function termination.
7369  *
7370  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function termination.
7371  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7372  *
7373  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7374  * @inst_id: the local instance id
7375  * @reason: termination reason (one of the NL80211_NAN_FUNC_TERM_REASON_*)
7376  * @gfp: allocation flags
7377  */
7378 void ieee80211_nan_func_terminated(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7379 				   u8 inst_id,
7380 				   enum nl80211_nan_func_term_reason reason,
7381 				   gfp_t gfp);
7382 
7383 /**
7384  * ieee80211_nan_func_match - notify about NAN function match event.
7385  *
7386  * This function is used to notify mac80211 about NAN function match. The
7387  * cookie inside the match struct will be assigned by mac80211.
7388  * Note that this function can't be called from hard irq.
7389  *
7390  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7391  * @match: match event information
7392  * @gfp: allocation flags
7393  */
7394 void ieee80211_nan_func_match(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7395 			      struct cfg80211_nan_match_params *match,
7396 			      gfp_t gfp);
7397 
7398 /**
7399  * ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for RX.
7400  *
7401  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7402  * rate information in the RX status struct and the frame length.
7403  *
7404  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7405  * @status: &struct ieee80211_rx_status containing the transmission rate
7406  *          information.
7407  * @len: frame length in bytes
7408  */
7409 u32 ieee80211_calc_rx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7410 			      struct ieee80211_rx_status *status,
7411 			      int len);
7412 
7413 /**
7414  * ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime - calculate estimated transmission airtime for TX.
7415  *
7416  * This function calculates the estimated airtime usage of a frame based on the
7417  * rate information in the TX info struct and the frame length.
7418  *
7419  * @hw: pointer as obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw()
7420  * @info: &struct ieee80211_tx_info of the frame.
7421  * @len: frame length in bytes
7422  */
7423 u32 ieee80211_calc_tx_airtime(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7424 			      struct ieee80211_tx_info *info,
7425 			      int len);
7426 /**
7427  * ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap - enable hardware encapsulation offloading.
7428  *
7429  * This function is used to notify mac80211 that a vif can be passed raw 802.3
7430  * frames. The driver needs to then handle the 802.11 encapsulation inside the
7431  * hardware or firmware.
7432  *
7433  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7434  * @enable: indicate if the feature should be turned on or off
7435  */
7436 bool ieee80211_set_hw_80211_encap(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, bool enable);
7437 
7438 /**
7439  * ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl - Get FILS discovery template.
7440  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7441  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7442  *
7443  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7444  *
7445  * Return: FILS discovery template. %NULL on error.
7446  */
7447 struct sk_buff *ieee80211_get_fils_discovery_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7448 						  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7449 
7450 /**
7451  * ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl - Get unsolicited broadcast
7452  *	probe response template.
7453  * @hw: pointer obtained from ieee80211_alloc_hw().
7454  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7455  *
7456  * The driver is responsible for freeing the returned skb.
7457  *
7458  * Return: Unsolicited broadcast probe response template. %NULL on error.
7459  */
7460 struct sk_buff *
7461 ieee80211_get_unsol_bcast_probe_resp_tmpl(struct ieee80211_hw *hw,
7462 					  struct ieee80211_vif *vif);
7463 
7464 /**
7465  * ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify - notify userland about a BSS color
7466  * collision.
7467  *
7468  * @vif: &struct ieee80211_vif pointer from the add_interface callback.
7469  * @color_bitmap: a 64 bit bitmap representing the colors that the local BSS is
7470  *	aware of.
7471  * @gfp: allocation flags
7472  */
7473 void
7474 ieee80211_obss_color_collision_notify(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7475 				      u64 color_bitmap, gfp_t gfp);
7476 
7477 /**
7478  * ieee80211_is_tx_data - check if frame is a data frame
7479  *
7480  * The function is used to check if a frame is a data frame. Frames with
7481  * hardware encapsulation enabled are data frames.
7482  *
7483  * @skb: the frame to be transmitted.
7484  */
7485 static inline bool ieee80211_is_tx_data(struct sk_buff *skb)
7486 {
7487 	struct ieee80211_tx_info *info = IEEE80211_SKB_CB(skb);
7488 	struct ieee80211_hdr *hdr = (void *) skb->data;
7489 
7490 	return info->flags & IEEE80211_TX_CTL_HW_80211_ENCAP ||
7491 	       ieee80211_is_data(hdr->frame_control);
7492 }
7493 
7494 /**
7495  * ieee80211_set_active_links - set active links in client mode
7496  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7497  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7498  *
7499  * Context: Must be called with wiphy mutex held; may sleep; calls
7500  *	back into the driver.
7501  *
7502  * This changes the active links on an interface. The interface
7503  * must be in client mode (in AP mode, all links are always active),
7504  * and @active_links must be a subset of the vif's valid_links.
7505  *
7506  * If a link is switched off and another is switched on at the same
7507  * time (e.g. active_links going from 0x1 to 0x10) then you will get
7508  * a sequence of calls like
7509  *
7510  *  - change_vif_links(0x11)
7511  *  - unassign_vif_chanctx(link_id=0)
7512  *  - change_sta_links(0x11) for each affected STA (the AP)
7513  *    (TDLS connections on now inactive links should be torn down)
7514  *  - remove group keys on the old link (link_id 0)
7515  *  - add new group keys (GTK/IGTK/BIGTK) on the new link (link_id 4)
7516  *  - change_sta_links(0x10) for each affected STA (the AP)
7517  *  - assign_vif_chanctx(link_id=4)
7518  *  - change_vif_links(0x10)
7519  */
7520 int ieee80211_set_active_links(struct ieee80211_vif *vif, u16 active_links);
7521 
7522 /**
7523  * ieee80211_set_active_links_async - asynchronously set active links
7524  * @vif: interface to set active links on
7525  * @active_links: the new active links bitmap
7526  *
7527  * See ieee80211_set_active_links() for more information, the only
7528  * difference here is that the link change is triggered async and
7529  * can be called in any context, but the link switch will only be
7530  * completed after it returns.
7531  */
7532 void ieee80211_set_active_links_async(struct ieee80211_vif *vif,
7533 				      u16 active_links);
7534 
7535 #endif /* MAC80211_H */
7536